blob: f30ab42fd9fac5a3be08beb5ff592adfaff1fb50 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau50bdda62015-07-22 17:32:56 +02007 2015/07/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020053
544. Proxies
554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
564.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
57
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200585. Bind and Server options
595.1. Bind options
605.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200615.3. Server DNS resolution
625.3.1. Global overview
635.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064
656. HTTP header manipulation
66
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
858. Logging
868.1. Log levels
878.2. Log formats
888.2.1. Default log format
898.2.2. TCP log format
908.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100918.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100928.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200938.3. Advanced logging options
948.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
958.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
968.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
978.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
988.4. Timing events
998.5. Session state at disconnection
1008.6. Non-printable characters
1018.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1028.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1038.9. Examples of logs
104
1059. Statistics and monitoring
1069.1. CSV format
1079.2. Unix Socket commands
108
109
1101. Quick reminder about HTTP
111----------------------------
112
113When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
114fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
115on almost anything found in the contents.
116
117However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
118formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
119correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
120
121
1221.1. The HTTP transaction model
123-------------------------------
124
125The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100126to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
128connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
129will involve a new connection :
130
131 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
132
133In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
134establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
135by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
136length.
137
138Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
139to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
140however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
141response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
142header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
143
144 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
145
146Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
147power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
148but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
151A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
152keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
153second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
154page :
155
156 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
157
158This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
159latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
160correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
161the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100162server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
165connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
166leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
167start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100169HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
170 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
171 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
172 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
173 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
174 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
175 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
1781.2. HTTP request
179-----------------
180
181First, let's consider this HTTP request :
182
183 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100184 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
186 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
187 3 User-agent: my small browser
188 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
189 5 Accept: image/png
190
191
1921.2.1. The Request line
193-----------------------
194
195Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
196
197 - a METHOD : GET
198 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
199 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
200
201All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
202which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
203followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
204is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
205desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
206the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
207
208The URI itself can have several forms :
209
210 - A "relative URI" :
211
212 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
213
214 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
215 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
216
217 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
218
219 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220
221 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
222 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
223 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
224 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
225 must accept this form too.
226
227 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
228 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
229 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
232 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
233 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
234 other protocols too.
235
236In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
237mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
238on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
239It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
240specific to the language, framework or application in use.
241
242
2431.2.2. The request headers
244--------------------------
245
246The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
247beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
248an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
249Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
250values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
251encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
252the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
253define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
254
255Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
256their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
257"Connection:" header).
258
259The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
260that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
261is one valid form of empty line.
262
263Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
264headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
265about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
266application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
267
268Important note:
269 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
270 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
271 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
272 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
273
274
2751.3. HTTP response
276------------------
277
278An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
279messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
280
281 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100282 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200283 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
284 2 Content-length: 350
285 3 Content-Type: text/html
286
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200287As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
288codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
289response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100290continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
291the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
292following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
293sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
294(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
295correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
296such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
297state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
298over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
299if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
300information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302
3031.3.1. The Response line
304------------------------
305
306Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
307
308 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
309 - a status code : 200
310 - a reason : OK
311
312The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200313 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200314 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
315 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
316 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
317 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
318
319Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
322messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
323or "Authentication Required".
324
325Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
326
327 Code When / reason
328 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
329 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100332 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334 400 for an invalid or too large request
335 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
336 accessing the stats page)
337 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
338 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
339 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
340 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
341 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
342 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
343 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
344 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
345 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
346
347The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3484.2).
349
350
3511.3.2. The response headers
352---------------------------
353
354Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
355the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
356details.
357
358
3592. Configuring HAProxy
360----------------------
361
3622.1. Configuration file format
363------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200364
365HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
366
367 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
368 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
369 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
370 "frontend" and "backend".
371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
373referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200374delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003772.2. Quoting and escaping
378-------------------------
379
380HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
381many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
382with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
383single quotes.
384
385If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
386them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
387escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
388
389Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
390
391 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
392 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
393 \\ to use a backslash
394 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
395 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
396
397Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
398the interpretation of:
399
400 space as a parameter separator
401 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
402 # hash as a comment start
403
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200404Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
405-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
406backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
407
408Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200409quoting.
410
411Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
412nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
413
414Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
415equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
416
417 Example:
418 # those are equivalents:
419 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
421 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
424
425 # those are equivalents:
426 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
427 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
430
431
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004322.3. Environment variables
433--------------------------
434
435HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
436interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
437configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
438optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
439shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
440underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
441
442 Example:
443
444 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
445
446 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
447
448 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
449
450
4512.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200452----------------
453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100454Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100455values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
456otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
457numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
458for every keyword. Supported units are :
459
460 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
461 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
462 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
463 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
464 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
465 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
466
467
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004682.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200469-------------
470
471 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
472 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
473 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
474 global
475 daemon
476 maxconn 256
477
478 defaults
479 mode http
480 timeout connect 5000ms
481 timeout client 50000ms
482 timeout server 50000ms
483
484 frontend http-in
485 bind *:80
486 default_backend servers
487
488 backend servers
489 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
490
491
492 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
493 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
494 global
495 daemon
496 maxconn 256
497
498 defaults
499 mode http
500 timeout connect 5000ms
501 timeout client 50000ms
502 timeout server 50000ms
503
504 listen http-in
505 bind *:80
506 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
507
508
509Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
510
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100511 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200512
513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005143. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515--------------------
516
517Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
518are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
519of them have command-line equivalents.
520
521The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
522
523 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200524 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900528 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - gid
530 - group
531 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100532 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200533 - nbproc
534 - pidfile
535 - uid
536 - ulimit-n
537 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200538 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100539 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200540 - node
541 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100542 - unix-bind
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100543 - 51degrees-data-file
544 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200545 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200546 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100547
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200549 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200551 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100552 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100553 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100554 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200555 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200556 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200557 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558 - noepoll
559 - nokqueue
560 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100561 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300562 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200563 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200564 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200565 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100566 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100567 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200568 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100569 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100570 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100571 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100572 - tune.lua.session-timeout
573 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100574 - tune.maxaccept
575 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200576 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200577 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200578 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100579 - tune.rcvbuf.client
580 - tune.rcvbuf.server
581 - tune.sndbuf.client
582 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100583 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100584 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200585 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100586 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200587 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200588 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200589 - tune.vars.global-max-size
590 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
591 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
592 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100593 - tune.zlib.memlevel
594 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100595
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200596 * Debugging
597 - debug
598 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599
600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006013.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602------------------------------------
603
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200604ca-base <dir>
605 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200606 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
607 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200608
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609chroot <jail dir>
610 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
611 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
612 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
613 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
614 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
615 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100616
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100617cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
618 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
619 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
620 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100621 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
622 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
623 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
624 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
625 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
626 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
627 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
628 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
629 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
630 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100631
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200632crt-base <dir>
633 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
634 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
635 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
636
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637daemon
638 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
639 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
640 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
641
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200642deviceatlas-json-file <path>
643 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
644 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
645
646deviceatlas-log-level <value>
647 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
648 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
649
650deviceatlas-separator <char>
651 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
652 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
653
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900654external-check
655 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
656 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
657 See "option external-check".
658
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200659gid <number>
660 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
661 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
662 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100663 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
664 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200665 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100666
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200667group <group name>
668 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
669 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100670
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200671log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
673 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100674 configured with "log global".
675
676 <address> can be one of:
677
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100678 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100679 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
680 port).
681
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100682 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
683 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
684 port).
685
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100686 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
687 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
688 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
689 writeable).
690
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200691 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
692 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100693
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200694 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
695 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
696 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
697 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
698 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
699 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
700 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
701 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
702 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
703 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
704 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
705
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100706 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200707
708 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
709 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
710 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
711
712 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200713 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
714 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
715 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
716 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
717 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
718 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200720 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100722log-send-hostname [<string>]
723 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
724 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
725 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
726 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
727 the logs.
728
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000729log-tag <string>
730 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
731 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
732 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100733 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000734
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100735lua-load <file>
736 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
737 used multiple times.
738
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200739nbproc <number>
740 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
741 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
742 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
743 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
744 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
745
746pidfile <pidfile>
747 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
748 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
749 starting the process. See also "daemon".
750
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100751stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200752 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
753 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
754 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
755 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
756 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
757 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100758 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200759 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
760 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200761
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100762ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
763 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
764 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300765 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100766 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
767 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
768 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
769 "bind" keyword for more information.
770
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100771ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
772 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
773 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
774 keyword to see available options.
775
776 Example:
777 global
778 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
779
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100780ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
781 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
782 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300783 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100784 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
785 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
786 information.
787
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100788ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
790 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
791 keyword to see available options.
792
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200793ssl-dh-param-file <file>
794 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
795 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
796 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
797 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
798 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
799 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them directly
800 in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size specified
801 by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are known to be
802 more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
803 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
804 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
805 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
806
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100807ssl-server-verify [none|required]
808 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
809 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
810 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
811
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200812stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
813 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
814 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
815 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
816 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200817
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200818 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
819 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
820 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200821
822stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
823 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
824 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100825 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200826
827stats maxconn <connections>
828 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
829 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
830
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200831uid <number>
832 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
833 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
834 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
835 one. See also "gid" and "user".
836
837ulimit-n <number>
838 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
839 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
840 option.
841
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100842unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
843 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
844
845 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
846 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
847 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
848 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
849 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
850 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
851 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
852 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
853 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
854 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
855
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200856user <user name>
857 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
858 See also "uid" and "group".
859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200860node <name>
861 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
862
863 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
864 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
865 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
866 traffic.
867
868description <text>
869 Add a text that describes the instance.
870
871 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
872 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
873 "<" and ">" characters.
874
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010087551degrees-data-file <file path>
876 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
877 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
878
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200879 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100880 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
881
88251degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
883 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
884 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
885 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
886
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200887 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100888 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
889
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020089051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100891 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
892 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
893
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200894 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
895 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
896
89751degrees-cache-size <number>
898 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
899 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
900 By default, this cache is disabled.
901
902 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100903 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
904
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009063.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200907-----------------------
908
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200909max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
910 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
911 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
912 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
913 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
914 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
915 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
916 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
917 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
918
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919maxconn <number>
920 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
921 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
922 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200923 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
924 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
925 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
926 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100927 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
928 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
929 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
930 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
931 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200933maxconnrate <number>
934 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
935 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
936 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
937 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
938 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
939 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
940 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
941 fairness.
942
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100943maxcomprate <number>
944 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300945 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100946 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
947 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
948 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
949 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
950 default value.
951
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100952maxcompcpuusage <number>
953 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
954 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
955 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
956 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
957 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
958 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
959 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
960 process down and from introducing high latencies.
961
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100962maxpipes <number>
963 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
964 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
965 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
966 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
967 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
968 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
969
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200970maxsessrate <number>
971 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
972 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
973 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
974 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
975 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
976 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
977 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
978 fairness.
979
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200980maxsslconn <number>
981 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
982 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
983 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
984 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
985 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
986 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
987 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100988 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
989 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
990 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
991 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
992 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
993 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
994 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200995
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200996maxsslrate <number>
997 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
998 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
999 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1000 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1001 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1002 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1003 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1004 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1005 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1006 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1007
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001008maxzlibmem <number>
1009 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1010 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1011 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001012 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1013 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1014 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1015
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016noepoll
1017 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1018 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001019 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020
1021nokqueue
1022 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1023 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1024 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1025
1026nopoll
1027 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1028 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001029 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001030 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001031
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001032nosplice
1033 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1034 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1035 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001036 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001037 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1038 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1039 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1040 "option splice-response".
1041
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001042nogetaddrinfo
1043 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1044 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1045
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001046spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001047 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1048 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1049 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1050 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1051 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1052 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001053
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001054tune.buffers.limit <number>
1055 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1056 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1057 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1058 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1059 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1060 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1061 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1062 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1063 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1064 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1065 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1066 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1067 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1068 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1069 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1070
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001071tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1072 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1073 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1074 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1075 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1076
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001077tune.bufsize <number>
1078 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1079 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1080 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1081 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1082 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1083 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1084 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1085 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001086 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1087 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1088 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001089
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001090tune.chksize <number>
1091 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1092 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1093 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1094 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1095 checks whenever possible.
1096
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001097tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1098 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1099 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1100 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1101 this value. The default value is 1.
1102
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001103tune.http.cookielen <number>
1104 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1105 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1106 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1107 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1108 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1109 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1110 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1111 to change this value.
1112
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001113tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1114 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1115 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1116 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1117 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1118 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1119 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1120 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1121 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1122 limit too high.
1123
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001124tune.idletimer <timeout>
1125 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1126 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1127 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1128 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1129 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1130 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1131 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1132 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1133 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1134
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001135tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1136 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1137 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1138 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1139 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1140 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1141 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1142 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1143
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001144tune.lua.maxmem
1145 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1146 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1147 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1148 memory.
1149
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001150tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1151 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1152 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1153 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1154 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1155 4s.
1156
1157tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1158 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1159 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1160 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1161 check servers.
1162
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001163tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001164 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1165 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1166 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1167 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1168 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1169 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1170 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1171 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1172 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1173 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001174
1175tune.maxpollevents <number>
1176 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1177 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1178 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1179 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1180 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1181
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001182tune.maxrewrite <number>
1183 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1184 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1185 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1186 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1187 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1188 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1189 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1190 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1191 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1192 bufsize.
1193
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001194tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1195 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1196 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1197 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1198 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1199 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1200 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1201 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1202 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1203 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1204 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1205 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1206 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1207 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1208 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1209 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1210 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1211 setting this parameter to 0.
1212
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001213tune.pipesize <number>
1214 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1215 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1216 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1217 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1218 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1219 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1220
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001221tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1222tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1223 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1224 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1225 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1226 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1227 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1228 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1229 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1230
1231tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1232tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1233 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1234 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1235 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1236 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1237 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1238 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1239 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1240 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1241 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1242 notifying haproxy again.
1243
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001244tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001245 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1246 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1247 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001248 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001249 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1250 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1251 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1252 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1253 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001254 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1255 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001256
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001257tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1258 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1259 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1260 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1261 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1262 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1263 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1264
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001265tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1266 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001267 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001268 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1269 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1270 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1271 being used for too long.
1272
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001273tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1274 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1275 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1276 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1277 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1278 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1279 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1280 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1281 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1282 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1283 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001284 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1285 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001286
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001287tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1288 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1289 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1290 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1291 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1292 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1293 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1294 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001295 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1296 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001297
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001298tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1299 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1300 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1301 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1302 1000 entries.
1303
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001304tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1305tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1306tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1307tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
1308 These four tunes helps to manage the allowed amount of memory used by the
1309 variables system. "global" limits the memory for all the systems. "sess" limit
1310 the memory by session, "txn" limits the memory by transaction and "reqres"
1311 limits the memory for each request or response processing. during the
1312 accounting, "sess" embbed "txn" and "txn" embed "reqres".
1313
1314 By example, we considers that "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is fixed to 100,
1315 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" is fixed to 100, "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" is
1316 also fixed to 100. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1317 we cannot create any more variable in the other contexts.
1318
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001319tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1320 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001321 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001322 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1323 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1324 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1325
1326tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1327 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1328 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1329 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1330 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013323.3. Debugging
1333--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001334
1335debug
1336 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1337 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1338 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1339 system startup.
1340
1341quiet
1342 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1343 line argument "-q".
1344
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013463.4. Userlists
1347--------------
1348It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1349http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1350it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1351
1352userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001353 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001354 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1355
1356group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001357 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001358 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1359 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1360
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001361user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1362 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001363 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1364 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001365 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1366 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001367 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001368 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001369
1370
1371 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001372 userlist L1
1373 group G1 users tiger,scott
1374 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001375
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001376 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1377 user scott insecure-password elgato
1378 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001379
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001380 userlist L2
1381 group G1
1382 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001383
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001384 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1385 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1386 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001387
1388 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001389
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001390
13913.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001392----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001393It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1394several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1395instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1396values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1397automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1398In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1399using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1400tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1401reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1402Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1403that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1404each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001405
1406peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001407 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001408 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1409
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001410disabled
1411 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1412 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1413 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1414
1415enable
1416 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1417
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001418peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1419 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1420 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1421 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1422 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1423 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1424 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1425
1426 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1427 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1428
1429 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1430 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1431 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1432 across all peers.
1433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001434 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1435 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001436
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001437 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001438 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001439 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1440 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1441 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001442
1443 backend mybackend
1444 mode tcp
1445 balance roundrobin
1446 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1447 stick on src
1448
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001449 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1450 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001451
1452
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090014533.6. Mailers
1454------------
1455It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1456If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1457in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1458
1459mailer <mailersect>
1460 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1461 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1462
1463mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1464 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1465
1466 Example:
1467 mailers mymailers
1468 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1469 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1470
1471 backend mybackend
1472 mode tcp
1473 balance roundrobin
1474
1475 email-alert mailers mymailers
1476 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1477 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1478
1479 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1480 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1481
1482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014834. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001484----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001485
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001486Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001487 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001488 - frontend <name>
1489 - backend <name>
1490 - listen <name>
1491
1492A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1493its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1494section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001495section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001496
1497A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1498connections.
1499
1500A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1501to forward incoming connections.
1502
1503A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1504parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001506All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1507'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1508case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1509
1510Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1511logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1512proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1513However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1514name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1515
1516Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1517and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001518bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001519protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1520modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1521arbitrary criteria.
1522
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001523In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1524a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1525the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1526
1527 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1528 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1529 between responses and new requests.
1530
1531 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1532 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1533 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1534 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1535
1536 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1537 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1538 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1539
1540 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1541 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1542 client-facing connection remains open.
1543
1544 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1545 after the end of the response.
1546
1547The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1548frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1549following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1550weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1551
1552 Backend mode
1553
1554 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1555 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1556 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1557 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1558 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1559 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1560 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1561 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1562 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1563 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1564 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001566
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015684.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1569--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001571The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1572limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1573they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1574limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001575marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001576option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001577and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1578with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1579specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001580
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001581
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001582 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1583------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1584acl - X X X
1585appsession - - X X
1586backlog X X X -
1587balance X - X X
1588bind - X X -
1589bind-process X X X X
1590block - X X X
1591capture cookie - X X -
1592capture request header - X X -
1593capture response header - X X -
1594clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001595compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001596contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1597cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001598declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001599default-server X - X X
1600default_backend X X X -
1601description - X X X
1602disabled X X X X
1603dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001604email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001605email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001606email-alert mailers X X X X
1607email-alert myhostname X X X X
1608email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001609enabled X X X X
1610errorfile X X X X
1611errorloc X X X X
1612errorloc302 X X X X
1613-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1614errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001615force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001616fullconn X - X X
1617grace X X X X
1618hash-type X - X X
1619http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001620http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001621http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001622http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001623http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001624http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001625http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001626id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001627ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001628log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001629log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001630log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001631max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001632maxconn X X X -
1633mode X X X X
1634monitor fail - X X -
1635monitor-net X X X -
1636monitor-uri X X X -
1637option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1638option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1639option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1640option allbackups (*) X - X X
1641option checkcache (*) X - X X
1642option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1643option contstats (*) X X X -
1644option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1645option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1646option forceclose (*) X X X X
1647-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1648option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001649option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001650option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001651option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001652option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001653option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001654option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001655option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001656option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1657option httpchk X - X X
1658option httpclose (*) X X X X
1659option httplog X X X X
1660option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001661option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001662option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001663option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001664option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1665option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1666option logasap (*) X X X -
1667option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001668option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001669option nolinger (*) X X X X
1670option originalto X X X X
1671option persist (*) X - X X
1672option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001673option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001674option smtpchk X - X X
1675option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1676option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1677option splice-request (*) X X X X
1678option splice-response (*) X X X X
1679option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1680option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1681-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001682option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001683option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1684option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1685option tcpka X X X X
1686option tcplog X X X X
1687option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001688external-check command X - X X
1689external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001690persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1691rate-limit sessions X X X -
1692redirect - X X X
1693redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1694redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1695reqadd - X X X
1696reqallow - X X X
1697reqdel - X X X
1698reqdeny - X X X
1699reqiallow - X X X
1700reqidel - X X X
1701reqideny - X X X
1702reqipass - X X X
1703reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001704reqitarpit - X X X
1705reqpass - X X X
1706reqrep - X X X
1707-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001708reqtarpit - X X X
1709retries X - X X
1710rspadd - X X X
1711rspdel - X X X
1712rspdeny - X X X
1713rspidel - X X X
1714rspideny - X X X
1715rspirep - X X X
1716rsprep - X X X
1717server - - X X
1718source X - X X
1719srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001720stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001721stats auth X - X X
1722stats enable X - X X
1723stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001724stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001725stats realm X - X X
1726stats refresh X - X X
1727stats scope X - X X
1728stats show-desc X - X X
1729stats show-legends X - X X
1730stats show-node X - X X
1731stats uri X - X X
1732-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1733stick match - - X X
1734stick on - - X X
1735stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001736stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001737stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001738tcp-check connect - - X X
1739tcp-check expect - - X X
1740tcp-check send - - X X
1741tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001742tcp-request connection - X X -
1743tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001744tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001745tcp-response content - - X X
1746tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001747timeout check X - X X
1748timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001749timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001750timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1751timeout connect X - X X
1752timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1753timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1754timeout http-request X X X X
1755timeout queue X - X X
1756timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001757timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001758timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1759timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001760timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001761transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001762unique-id-format X X X -
1763unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001764use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001765use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001766------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1767 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017704.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1771---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001772
1773This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1774
1775
1776acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1777 Declare or complete an access list.
1778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1779 no | yes | yes | yes
1780 Example:
1781 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1782 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1783 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001785 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786
1787
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001788appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1789 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1792 no | no | yes | yes
1793 Arguments :
1794 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1795 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1796
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001797 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798 checked in each cookie value.
1799
1800 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1801 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1802 milliseconds.
1803
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001804 request-learn
1805 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1806 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1807 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1808 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1809 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1810 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1811
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001812 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1813 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1814 data following this prefix.
1815
1816 Example :
1817 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1818
1819 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1820 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1821
1822 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1823 2 modes are currently supported :
1824 - path-parameters :
1825 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1826 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1827 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1828 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1829 - query-string :
1830 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1831 query string.
1832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001833 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1834 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1835 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1836 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001837 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1838 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1839 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001840 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1841 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1842
1843 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1844
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001845 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1846 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1847 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1848
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001849 Example :
1850 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1851
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001852 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1853 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001854
1855
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001856backlog <conns>
1857 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1859 yes | yes | yes | no
1860 Arguments :
1861 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1862 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001863 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001864
1865 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1866 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1867 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1868 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1869 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1870 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1871 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1872 backlog parameter.
1873
1874 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1875 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1876 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1877
1878 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1879
1880
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001881balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001882balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1885 yes | no | yes | yes
1886 Arguments :
1887 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1888 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1889 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1890 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1891
1892 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1893 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1894 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1895 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001896 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001897 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001898 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1899 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1900 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1901 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1902 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1903 it, so that you don't worry.
1904
1905 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1906 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1907 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1908 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1909 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1910 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1911 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1912 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001913
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001914 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1915 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1916 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1917 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1918 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1919 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1920 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1921 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1922
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001923 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001924 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001925 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1926 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001927 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001928 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1929 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1930 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1931 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1932 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001933 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1934 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1935 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1936 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1937 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1938 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001939
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001940 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1941 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1942 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1943 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1944 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1945 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1946 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1947 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001948 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001949 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001950 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1951 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1952 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001953
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001954 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1955 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1956 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1957 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1958 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1959 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1960 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1961 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1962 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1963 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1964 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1965 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001966
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001967 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001968 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1969 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1970 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1971 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1972 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1973 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1974 URIs start with a leading "/".
1975
1976 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1977 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1978 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1979 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1980
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001981 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001982 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1983
1984 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001985 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1986 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001987 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1988 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1989 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1990 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001991 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001992 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1993 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001994
1995 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1996 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1997 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1998 server will receive the request.
1999
2000 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2001 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2002 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2003 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2004 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002005 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2006 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2007 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002008
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002009 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2010 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2011 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2012 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2013 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002014
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002015 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002016 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2017 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2018 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2019
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002020 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2021 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2022 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2023
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002024 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002025 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002026 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2027 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2028 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2029 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2030 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2031 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002032 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002033 used instead.
2034
2035 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2036 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2037 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2038 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2039
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002040 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2041 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2042 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2043
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002044 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002045
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002047 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2048 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002049
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002050 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2051 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2052 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053
2054 Examples :
2055 balance roundrobin
2056 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002057 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002058 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2059 balance hdr(host)
2060 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002061
2062 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2063 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002065 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002066 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2067 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2068 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2069 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2070
2071 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2072 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2073 defaults to 16 kB.
2074
2075 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2076 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2077
2078 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2079 Round Robin.
2080
2081 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2082 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2083 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2084 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2085
2086 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2087
2088 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002089 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002090 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2091 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2092 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002093
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002094 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
2095 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002096
2097
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002098bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2099bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002100 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2102 no | yes | yes | no
2103 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002104 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2105 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2106 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2107 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002108 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002109 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2110 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2111 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2112 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2113 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2114 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2115 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002116 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2117 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2118 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2119 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2120 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2121 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2122 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002123 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2124 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2125 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002126 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2127 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2128 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002129
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002130 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2131 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002132 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2133 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2134 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002135 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2136 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2137 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2138 the range.
2139
2140 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2141 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2142 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2143 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2144 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2145 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2146 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002147 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002148 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002149
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002150 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2151 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2152 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2153 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2154 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2155 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2156 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2157 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2158
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002159 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2160 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2161 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2162 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002163
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002164 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2165 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2166 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2167 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2168 in a frontend.
2169
2170 Example :
2171 listen http_proxy
2172 bind :80,:443
2173 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002174 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002175
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002176 listen http_https_proxy
2177 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002178 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002179
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002180 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2181 bind ipv6@:80
2182 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2183 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2184
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002185 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002186 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002187
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002188 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002189 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002190
2191
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002192bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002193 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2195 yes | yes | yes | yes
2196 Arguments :
2197 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2198 may be used to override a default value.
2199
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002200 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002201 option may be combined with other numbers.
2202
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002203 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002204 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2205 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2206 missing from all processes.
2207
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002208 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002209 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002210 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2211 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2212 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2213 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002214
2215 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2216 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2217 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2218 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2219 and 'even' instances.
2220
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002221 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2222 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2223 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2224 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002225
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002226 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2227 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2228
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002229 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2230 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2231 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2232
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002233 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2234 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2235
2236 Example :
2237 listen app_ip1
2238 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002239 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002240
2241 listen app_ip2
2242 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002243 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002244
2245 listen management
2246 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002247 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002248
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002249 listen management
2250 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2251 bind-process 1-4
2252
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002253 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002254
2255
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002256block { if | unless } <condition>
2257 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2259 no | yes | yes | yes
2260
2261 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2262 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002263 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002264 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002265 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2266 "block" statements per instance.
2267
2268 Example:
2269 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2270 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2271 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2272 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002274 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002275
2276
2277capture cookie <name> len <length>
2278 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2280 no | yes | yes | no
2281 Arguments :
2282 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2283 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2284 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2285 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2286 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2287
2288 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2289 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2290 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2291 right if it exceeds <length>.
2292
2293 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2294 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2295 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2296 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2297
2298 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2299 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2300 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2301
2302 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2303 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2304 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002305 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2306 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2307 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002308
2309 Example:
2310 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2311
2312 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002313 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002314
2315
2316capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002317 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2319 no | yes | yes | no
2320 Arguments :
2321 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002322 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2324 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2325 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2326
2327 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2328 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2329 it exceeds <length>.
2330
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002331 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2333 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002334 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2335 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2336 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2337 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002338 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002339 environments to find where the request came from.
2340
2341 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2342 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2343 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2344 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002346 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2347 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2348 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2349 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2350 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002351
2352 Example:
2353 capture request header Host len 15
2354 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2355 capture request header Referrer len 15
2356
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002357 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002358 about logging.
2359
2360
2361capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002362 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2364 no | yes | yes | no
2365 Arguments :
2366 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002367 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002368 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2369 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2370 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2371
2372 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2373 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2374 it exceeds <length>.
2375
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002376 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002377 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2378 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2379 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002380 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2381 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2382 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2383 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002384
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002385 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2386 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2387 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2388 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2389 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390
2391 Example:
2392 capture response header Content-length len 9
2393 capture response header Location len 15
2394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002395 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396 about logging.
2397
2398
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002399clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002400 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2402 yes | yes | yes | no
2403 Arguments :
2404 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2405 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2406 as explained at the top of this document.
2407
2408 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2409 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2410 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2411 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2412 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2413 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2414 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2415 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002416 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002417 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2418 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2419
2420 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2421 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2422 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2423 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2424 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2425 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2426
2427 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2428 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2429
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002430 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2431 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002432
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002433compression algo <algorithm> ...
2434compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002435compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002436 Enable HTTP compression.
2437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2438 yes | yes | yes | yes
2439 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002440 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2441 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2442 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2443
2444 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002445 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2446 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2447 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002448
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002449 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2450 support for zlib was built in.
2451
2452 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2453 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2454 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2455 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2456 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2457 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002458
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002459 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2460 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2461 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2462 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2463 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2464 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2465 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2466 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002467
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002468 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002469 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002470 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2471 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2472 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2473 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2474 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002475
2476 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2477 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2478 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2479 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2480 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002481 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2482 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2483 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2484 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2485 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002486 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2487 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002488
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002489 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002490 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2491 "Accept-Encoding" header
2492 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002493 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002494 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2495 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002496 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2497 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2498 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2499 "multipart"
2500 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2501 header
2502 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2503 and later
2504 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2505 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002506
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002507 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2508 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002509
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002510 Examples :
2511 compression algo gzip
2512 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002513
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002514contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002515 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2517 yes | no | yes | yes
2518 Arguments :
2519 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2520 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2521 as explained at the top of this document.
2522
2523 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002524 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002525 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002526 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2527 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2528 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2529 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2530
2531 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2532 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2533 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2534 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2535 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2536 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2537
2538 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2539 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2540 instead.
2541
2542 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2543 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2544
2545
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002546cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002547 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2548 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002549 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2551 yes | no | yes | yes
2552 Arguments :
2553 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2554 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2555 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2556 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2557 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2558 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2559 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2560 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2561 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2562
2563 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2564 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2565 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2566 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2567 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2568 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2569 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2570 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2571 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2572 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2573 "insert" and "prefix".
2574
2575 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002576 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002577
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002578 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002579 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2580 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2581 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2582 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2583 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2584 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2585 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2586 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2587 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2588 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002589
2590 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2591 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2592 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2593 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2594 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2595 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2596 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2597 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2598 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2599 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002600 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2601 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2602 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002604 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2605 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2606 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002607 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2608 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2609 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2610 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002611 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2612 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2613 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002614
2615 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2616 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2617 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2618 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2619 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2620 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2621 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2622 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2623 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2624
2625 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2626 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2627 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2628 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2629 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2630 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2631 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2632 persistence cookie in the cache.
2633 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2634
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002635 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2636 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2637 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2638 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2639 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2640 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2641 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2642 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2643 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2644 they logout.
2645
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002646 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2647 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2648 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2649 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2650
2651 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2652 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2653 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2654 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2655 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2656 this attribute.
2657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002658 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002659 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002660 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2661 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2662 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2663 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2664 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2665 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002666
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002667 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2668 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2669 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2670 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2671 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2672 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2673 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2674 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2675 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2676 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2677 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2678 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2679 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2680 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2681 the site.
2682
2683 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2684 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2685 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2686 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2687 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2688 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2689 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2690 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2691 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2692 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2693 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2694 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2695 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2696 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2697 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2698 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2699
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2701 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2702 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2703 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002704
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002705 Examples :
2706 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2707 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2708 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002709 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002710
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002711 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002712 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002713
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002714
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002715declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2716 Declares a capture slot.
2717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2718 no | yes | yes | no
2719 Arguments:
2720 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2721
2722 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2723 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2724 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2725 for use in the response.
2726
2727 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
2728 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2729
2730
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002731default-server [param*]
2732 Change default options for a server in a backend
2733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2734 yes | no | yes | yes
2735 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002736 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2737 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2738 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2739 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002740
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002741 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002742 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2743
2744 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002745
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002747default_backend <backend>
2748 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2750 yes | yes | yes | no
2751 Arguments :
2752 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2753
2754 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2755 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2756 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2757 will catch all undetermined requests.
2758
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002759 Example :
2760
2761 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2762 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2763 default_backend dynamic
2764
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002765 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002766
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002767
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002768description <string>
2769 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2771 no | yes | yes | yes
2772 Arguments : string
2773
2774 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2775 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2776 it describes.
2777 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2778
2779
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002780disabled
2781 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2783 yes | yes | yes | yes
2784 Arguments : none
2785
2786 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2787 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2788 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2789 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2790 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2791 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2792 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2793
2794 See also : "enabled"
2795
2796
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002797dispatch <address>:<port>
2798 Set a default server address
2799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2800 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002801 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002802
2803 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2804 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2805 during start-up.
2806
2807 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2808 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2809 possible with normal servers.
2810
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002811 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002812 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2813 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2814 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2815 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2816
2817 See also : "server"
2818
2819
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002820enabled
2821 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2823 yes | yes | yes | yes
2824 Arguments : none
2825
2826 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2827 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2828
2829 See also : "disabled"
2830
2831
2832errorfile <code> <file>
2833 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2835 yes | yes | yes | yes
2836 Arguments :
2837 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002838 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2839 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840
2841 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002842 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002843 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002844 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2845 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002846
2847 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2848 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2849 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2850
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002851 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2852
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002853 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2854 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2855 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2856 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2857
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002858 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2859 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2860 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2861 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2862 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2863 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2864
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002865 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2866 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2867 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002868 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002869 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2870
2871 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2872
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002873 Example :
2874 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002875 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002876 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2877 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2878
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002879
2880errorloc <code> <url>
2881errorloc302 <code> <url>
2882 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2884 yes | yes | yes | yes
2885 Arguments :
2886 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002887 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002888
2889 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2890 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2891 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2892 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2893 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2894
2895 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2896 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2897 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2898
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002899 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2900
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002901 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2902 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2903 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2904 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2905 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2906 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2907 request.
2908
2909 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2910
2911
2912errorloc303 <code> <url>
2913 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2915 yes | yes | yes | yes
2916 Arguments :
2917 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2918 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2919
2920 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2921 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2922 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2923 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2924 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2925
2926 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2927 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2928 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2929
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002930 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2931
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002932 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2933 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2934 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2935 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002936 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002937
2938 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2939
2940
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002941email-alert from <emailaddr>
2942 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2943 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2944 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2945 yes | yes | yes | yes
2946
2947 Arguments :
2948
2949 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2950
2951 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2952 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2953
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002954 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2955 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2956
2957
2958email-alert level <level>
2959 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2960 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2961 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2962 yes | yes | yes | yes
2963
2964 Arguments :
2965
2966 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2967 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2968 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2969
2970 By default level is alert
2971
2972 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2973 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2974 for the proxy.
2975
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002976 Alerts are sent when :
2977
2978 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2979 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2980 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2981 is notice or lower
2982 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2983 and a health check status update occurs
2984
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002985 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2986 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002987 section 3.6 about mailers.
2988
2989
2990email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2991 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2992 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2993 yes | yes | yes | yes
2994
2995 Arguments :
2996
2997 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2998
2999 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3000 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3001
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003002 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3003 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003004
3005
3006email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3007 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3008 mailers.
3009 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3010 yes | yes | yes | yes
3011
3012 Arguments :
3013
3014 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3015
3016 By default the systems hostname is used.
3017
3018 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3019 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3020 for the proxy.
3021
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003022 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3023 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003024
3025
3026email-alert to <emailaddr>
3027 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3028 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3029 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3030 yes | yes | yes | yes
3031
3032 Arguments :
3033
3034 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3035
3036 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3037 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3038
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003039 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003040 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3041
3042
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003043force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3044 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3045 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3046 no | yes | yes | yes
3047
3048 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3049 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3050 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3051 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3052 marked down for maintenance operations.
3053
3054 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3055 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3056 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3057 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3058 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3059 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3060 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3061 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3062 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3063
3064 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3065 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3066 is used.
3067
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003068 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003069 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003070
3071
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003072fullconn <conns>
3073 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3075 yes | no | yes | yes
3076 Arguments :
3077 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3078 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3079
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003080 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003081 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003082 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003083 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3084 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3085 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3086 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3087 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003088 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003089
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003090 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3091 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003092 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3093 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3094 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003095
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003096 Example :
3097 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3098 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3099 # connections.
3100 backend dynamic
3101 fullconn 10000
3102 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3103 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3104
3105 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3106
3107
3108grace <time>
3109 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003111 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003112 Arguments :
3113 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3114 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3115 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3116
3117 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3118 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003119 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003120 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3121
3122 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3123 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3124 simplify it.
3125
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003126
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003127hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003128 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3130 yes | no | yes | yes
3131 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003132 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3133 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003134
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003135 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3136 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3137 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3138 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3139 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3140 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3141 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3142 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3143 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3144 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003145
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003146 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3147 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3148 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3149 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3150 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3151 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3152 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3153 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3154 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3155 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3156 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3157 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3158 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003159 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3160 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003161
3162 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3163
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003164 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003165 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3166 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3167 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003168 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3169 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3170 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003171
3172 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3173 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003174 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3175 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3176 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3177 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3178
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003179 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3180 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3181 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3182 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3183 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3184 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3185 parameter.
3186
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003187 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3188 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3189 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3190 used on strings.
3191
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003192 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3193
3194 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3195 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3196 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3197 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3198 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3199 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3200 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3201 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3202 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3203 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3204 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3205 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003206
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003207 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3208 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3209 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003210
3211 See also : "balance", "server"
3212
3213
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003214http-check disable-on-404
3215 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003217 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003218 Arguments : none
3219
3220 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3221 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3222 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3223 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3224 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3225 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3226 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3227 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003228 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3229 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3230 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3231
3232 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3233
3234
3235http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003236 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003238 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003239 Arguments :
3240 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3241 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003242 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003243 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3244 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3245 details on the supported keywords.
3246
3247 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3248 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3249 with the usual backslash ('\').
3250
3251 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3252 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3253 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3254 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3255 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3256
3257 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003258 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003259 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3260 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3261 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3262
3263 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003264 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003265 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3266 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3267 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3268 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3269
3270 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003271 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003272 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3273 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3274 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3275 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3276 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3277 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3278 trace).
3279
3280 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003281 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003282 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3283 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3284 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3285 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3286 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3287 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3288
3289 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3290 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3291 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3292 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3293 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3294 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3295 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3296 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3297
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003298 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3299 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3300 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3301
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003302 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3303 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3304
3305 Examples :
3306 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003307 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003308
3309 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003310 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003311
3312 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003313 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003314
3315 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003316 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003317
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003318 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003319
3320
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003321http-check send-state
3322 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3324 yes | no | yes | yes
3325 Arguments : none
3326
3327 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3328 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3329 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3330 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3331 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3332
3333 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3334 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3335 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3336 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3337 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003338 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3339 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3340 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3341
3342 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3343 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3344 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3345
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003346 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3347 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3348 checked in multiple backends.
3349
3350 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3351 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3352
3353 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3354 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3355 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3356 one fails.
3357
3358 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3359 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3360 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3361
3362 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3363 server's queue.
3364
3365 Example of a header received by the application server :
3366 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3367 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3368
3369 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3370
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003371http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003372 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003373 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003374 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003375 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3376 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003377 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3378 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003379 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3380 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3381 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003382 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003383 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003384 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3385 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003386 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003387 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003388 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3389
3390 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3391 no | yes | yes | yes
3392
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003393 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3394 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3395 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3396 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3397 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003398
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003399 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3400 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3401 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3402
3403 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3404 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3405 are evaluated.
3406
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003407 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3408 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3409 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3410 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3411 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3412 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3413 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3414 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3415 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003416 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003417 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3418
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003419 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3420 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3421 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3422 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3423 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3424
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003425 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3426 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3427 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003428 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3429 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003430
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003431 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3432 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3433 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3434 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3435 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3436 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3437 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3438 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3439
3440 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3441 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3442 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003443 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3444 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003445
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003446 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3447 <name>.
3448
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003449 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3450 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3451 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3452 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3453 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3454 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3455 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3456 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3457
3458 Example:
3459
3460 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3461
3462 applied to:
3463
3464 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3465
3466 outputs:
3467
3468 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3469
3470 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3471
3472 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3473 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3474 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3475 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3476 header.
3477
3478 Example:
3479
3480 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3481
3482 applied to:
3483
3484 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3485
3486 outputs:
3487
3488 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3489
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003490 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3491 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3492 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3493 it.
3494
3495 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3496 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3497 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3498 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3499 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3500 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3501
3502 Example :
3503 # prepend the host name before the path
3504 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3505
3506 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3507 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3508 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3509 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3510 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3511 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3512 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3513 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3514
3515 Example :
3516 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3517 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3518
3519 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3520 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3521 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3522 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3523 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3524 "set-query".
3525
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003526 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3527 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3528 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3529 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3530 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3531 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3532 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3533 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3534
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003535 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3536 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3537 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3538 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3539 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3540 another equipment.
3541
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003542 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3543 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3544 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3545 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3546 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3547 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3548 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3549 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3550
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003551 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3552 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3553 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3554 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3555 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3556 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3557 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3558 admin privileges.
3559
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003560 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3561 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3562 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3563 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3564 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3565 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3566 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3567 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3568
3569 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3570 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3571 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3572 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3573 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3574 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3575
3576 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3577 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3578 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3579 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3580 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3581 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3582
3583 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3584 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3585 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3586 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3587 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3588 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3589 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3590 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3591 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3592
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003593 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003594 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3595 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3596 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3597 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3598 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3599 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3600 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3601 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3602 request header" for more information.
3603
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003604 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3605 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3606 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3607 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
3608
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003609 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3610 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3611 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3612 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3613 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3614 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3615 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3616 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3617 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3618 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3619 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3620 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3621
3622 These actions take one or two arguments :
3623 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3624 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3625 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3626 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3627
3628 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3629 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3630 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3631 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3632
3633 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3634 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3635 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3636 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3637 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3638 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3639 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3640 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3641
3642 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3643 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3644 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3645 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3646 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3647
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003648 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3649 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3650 function is documented in the API documentation.
3651
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003652 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3653 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3654 inline.
3655
3656 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3657 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3658 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3659 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3660 (request and response)
3661 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3662 processing
3663 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3664 processing.
3665 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3666 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3667 and '_'.
3668
3669 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3670 followed by some converters.
3671
3672 Example:
3673
3674 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3675
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003676 - set-src <expr> :
3677 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3678 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3679 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3680 source IP for privacy.
3681
3682 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3683 followed by some converters.
3684
3685 Example:
3686
3687 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3688 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3689
3690 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3691
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003692 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3693
3694 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3695 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3696 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3697 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003698
3699 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003700 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3701 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3702 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003703
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003704 http-request allow if nagios
3705 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3706 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3707 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003708
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003709 Example:
3710 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003711 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003712
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003713 Example:
3714 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3715 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3716 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3717 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3718 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3719 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3720 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3721 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3722 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3723
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003724 Example:
3725 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3726 acl add path /addacl
3727 acl del path /delacl
3728
3729 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3730
3731 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3732 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3733
3734 Example:
3735 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3736 acl setmap path /setmap
3737 acl delmap path /delmap
3738
3739 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3740
3741 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3742 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3743
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003744 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3745 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003746
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003747http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003748 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003749 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003750 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3751 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003752 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3753 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3754 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3755 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003756 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003757 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003758 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003759 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003760 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003761 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3762
3763 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3764 no | yes | yes | yes
3765
3766 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3767 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3768 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3769 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3770 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3771 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3772
3773 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3774 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3775 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3776 current section.
3777
3778 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3779 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3780 rules are evaluated.
3781
3782 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3783 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3784 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3785 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3786 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3787 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3788 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3789
3790 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3791 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3792 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3793 external users.
3794
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003795 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3796 <name>.
3797
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003798 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3799 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3800 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3801 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3802 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3803 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3804 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3805 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3806
3807 Example:
3808
3809 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3810
3811 applied to:
3812
3813 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3814
3815 outputs:
3816
3817 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3818
3819 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3820
3821 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3822 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3823 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3824 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3825 header.
3826
3827 Example:
3828
3829 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3830
3831 applied to:
3832
3833 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3834
3835 outputs:
3836
3837 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3838
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003839 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3840 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3841 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3842 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3843 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3844 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3845 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3846 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3847
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003848 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3849 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3850 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3851 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3852 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3853 another equipment.
3854
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003855 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3856 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3857 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3858 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3859 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3860 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3861 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3862 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3863
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003864 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3865 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3866 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3867 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3868 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3869 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3870 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3871 admin privileges.
3872
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003873 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3874 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3875 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3876 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3877 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3878 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3879 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3880 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3881
3882 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3883 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3884 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3885 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3886 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3887 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3888
3889 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3890 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3891 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3892 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3893 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3894 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3895
3896 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3897 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3898 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3899 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3900 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3901 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3902 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3903 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3904 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3905
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003906 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3907 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3908 function is documented in the API documentation.
3909
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02003910 - capture <sample> id <id> :
3911 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
3912 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
3913 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
3914 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
3915 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
3916 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3917 response header" for more information.
3918
3919 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
3920 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
3921 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
3922 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
3923 keyword.
3924
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003925 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3926 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
3927 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
3928 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
3929 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
3930 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
3931
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003932 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
3933 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3934 inline.
3935
3936 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3937 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3938 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3939 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3940 (request and response)
3941 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3942 processing
3943 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3944 processing.
3945 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3946 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3947 and '_'.
3948
3949 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3950 followed by some converters.
3951
3952 Example:
3953
3954 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
3955
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003956 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3957
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003958 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003959 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3960 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3961 rules.
3962
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003963 Example:
3964 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3965
3966 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3967
3968 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3969 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3970
3971 Example:
3972 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3973
3974 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3975
3976 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3977 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3978
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003979 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3980 ACL usage.
3981
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003982
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003983http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
3984 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
3985
3986 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3987 yes | no | yes | yes
3988
3989 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
3990 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
3991 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
3992 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
3993 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
3994 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
3995
3996 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
3997
3998 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
3999 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4000 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4001 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4002 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4003 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4004 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4005 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4006 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4007 not checking any request past the first one.
4008
4009 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4010 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4011 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4012 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4013 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4014 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4015 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4016
4017 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4018 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4019 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4020 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4021 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4022 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4023 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4024 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4025 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4026 downsides of rare connection failures.
4027
4028 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4029 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4030 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4031 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4032 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4033 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4034 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4035 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4036 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4037 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4038 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4039 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4040
4041 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4042 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4043 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4044 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4045
4046 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4047 and are never shared ;
4048
4049 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4050 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4051 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4052 and are never shared ;
4053
4054 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4055 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4056 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4057
4058 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4059 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4060 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4061
4062 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4063
4064
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004065http-send-name-header [<header>]
4066 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4067
4068 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4069 yes | no | yes | yes
4070
4071 Arguments :
4072
4073 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4074
4075 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4076 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4077 is added with the header string proved.
4078
4079 See also : "server"
4080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004081id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004082 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4084 no | yes | yes | yes
4085 Arguments : none
4086
4087 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4088 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4089 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004090
4091
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004092ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4093 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4095 no | yes | yes | yes
4096
4097 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4098 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4099 and running).
4100
4101 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4102 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4103 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004104 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004105 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4106
4107 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
4108 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
4109
4110 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4111 "unless" condition is met.
4112
4113 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4114
4115
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004116log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004117log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004118no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004119 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4121 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004122
4123 Prefix :
4124 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4125 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4126 prefix does not allow arguments.
4127
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004128 Arguments :
4129 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4130 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4131 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4132 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4133 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4134 parameter.
4135
4136 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4137 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4138
4139 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4140 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4141 standard syslog port).
4142
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004143 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4144 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4145 standard syslog port).
4146
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004147 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4148 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4149 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4150 appropriately writeable).
4151
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004152 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4153 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004154
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004155 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4156 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4157 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4158 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4159 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4160 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4161 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4162 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4163 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4164 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4165 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4166
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004167 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4168
4169 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4170 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4171 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4172
4173 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4174 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4175 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004176 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4177 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4178 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4179 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4180 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004181
4182 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4183
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004184 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4185 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4186 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004187
4188 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4189 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4190 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4191 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4192
4193 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4194 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004195
4196 Example :
4197 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004198 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4199 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004200 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004201
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004202
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004203log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004204 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4206 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004207
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004208 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4209 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4210 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4211 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4212 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004213
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004214log-tag <string>
4215 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4216 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4217 yes | yes | yes | yes
4218
4219 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4220 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4221 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4222 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4223 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4224 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4225 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4226 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4227 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004228
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004229max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4230 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4231 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4232 yes | no | yes | yes
4233
4234 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4235 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4236 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4237 servers.
4238
4239 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4240 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4241 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4242 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4243 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4244 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4245 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4246 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4247 picking a different server.
4248
4249 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4250 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4251 even if they have to be queued.
4252
4253 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4254 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4255
4256
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004257maxconn <conns>
4258 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4260 yes | yes | yes | no
4261 Arguments :
4262 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4263 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4264 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4265 closes.
4266
4267 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4268 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4269 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4270 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4271 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4272 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4273 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4274 properly tuned.
4275
4276 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4277 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4278 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4279
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004280 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4281
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004282 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4283
4284
4285mode { tcp|http|health }
4286 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4288 yes | yes | yes | yes
4289 Arguments :
4290 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4291 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4292 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4293 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4294
4295 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4296 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4297 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4298 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4299 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4300
4301 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004302 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4303 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4304 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4305 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4306 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4307 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4308 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004309
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004310 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4311 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4312 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004313
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004314 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004315 defaults http_instances
4316 mode http
4317
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004318 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004321monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004322 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4324 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004325 Arguments :
4326 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4327 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004328 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004329 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4330 backend and its backup.
4331
4332 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4333 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4334 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4335 servers in a list of backends.
4336
4337 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4338 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4339 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4340 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4341 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4342 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4343 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004344 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4345 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004346
4347 Example:
4348 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004349 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004350 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4351 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4352 monitor-uri /site_alive
4353 monitor fail if site_dead
4354
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004355 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004356
4357
4358monitor-net <source>
4359 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4361 yes | yes | yes | no
4362 Arguments :
4363 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4364 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4365 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4366 followed by a mask.
4367
4368 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4369 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004370 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004371 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4372
4373 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4374 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4375 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4376 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004377 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4378 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4379 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004380
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004381 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4382 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4383 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4384 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4385 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4386 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004387
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004388 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4389 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004390
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004391 Example :
4392 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4393 frontend www
4394 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4395
4396 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4397
4398
4399monitor-uri <uri>
4400 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4402 yes | yes | yes | no
4403 Arguments :
4404 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4405 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4406
4407 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4408 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4409 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4410 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4411 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4412 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4413 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4414 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4415
4416 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4417 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4418 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4419 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4420 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4421 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4422
4423 Example :
4424 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4425 frontend www
4426 mode http
4427 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4428
4429 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4430
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004431
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004432option abortonclose
4433no option abortonclose
4434 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4436 yes | no | yes | yes
4437 Arguments : none
4438
4439 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4440 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4441 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4442 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004443 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004444 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4445 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4446 encountered while delivering the response.
4447
4448 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4449 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4450 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4451 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4452 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4453 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004454 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004455 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004456 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004457 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4458 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4459 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4460
4461 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4462 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4463 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4464 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4465 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4466 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4467 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4468 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004469 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004470
4471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4473
4474 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4475
4476
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004477option accept-invalid-http-request
4478no option accept-invalid-http-request
4479 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4481 yes | yes | yes | no
4482 Arguments : none
4483
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004484 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004485 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4486 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4487 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4488 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4489 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4490 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4491 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004492 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4493 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4494 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4495 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4496 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004497 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004498 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4499 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4500 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004501
4502 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4503 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4504 been confirmed.
4505
4506 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4507 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004508 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4509 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004510 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4511
4512 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4513 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4514
4515 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4516 stats socket.
4517
4518
4519option accept-invalid-http-response
4520no option accept-invalid-http-response
4521 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4523 yes | no | yes | yes
4524 Arguments : none
4525
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004526 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004527 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4528 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4529 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4530 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4531 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4532 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4533 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004534 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4535 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4536 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004537
4538 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4539 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4540 been confirmed.
4541
4542 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4543 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4544 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4545 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4546
4547 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4548 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4549
4550 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4551 stats socket.
4552
4553
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004554option allbackups
4555no option allbackups
4556 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4558 yes | no | yes | yes
4559 Arguments : none
4560
4561 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4562 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4563 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4564 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4565 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4566 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4567 order between the backup servers anymore.
4568
4569 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4570 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4571
4572 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4573 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4574
4575
4576option checkcache
4577no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004578 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4580 yes | no | yes | yes
4581 Arguments : none
4582
4583 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4584 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004585 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004586 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4587 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004588 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004589
4590 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004591 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004592 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004593 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4594 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004595 to the client are :
4596 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004597 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004598 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004599 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4600 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4601 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4602 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4603 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4604 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4605 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4606 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4607 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4608 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4609 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4610
4611 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004612 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004613 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004614 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004615 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4616
4617 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4618 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004619 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004620 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4621
4622 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4623 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4624
4625
4626option clitcpka
4627no option clitcpka
4628 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4630 yes | yes | yes | no
4631 Arguments : none
4632
4633 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4634 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4635 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4636 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4637
4638 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4639 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4640 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4641 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4642
4643 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4644 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4645 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4646 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4647 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4648
4649 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4650
4651 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4652 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4653 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4654
4655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4657
4658 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4659
4660
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004661option contstats
4662 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4664 yes | yes | yes | no
4665 Arguments : none
4666
4667 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4668 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4669 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4670 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4671 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4672 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4673 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4674
4675
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004676option dontlog-normal
4677no option dontlog-normal
4678 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4680 yes | yes | yes | no
4681 Arguments : none
4682
4683 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4684 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4685 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4686 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4687 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4688 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4689 logged.
4690
4691 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4692 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4693 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004695 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004696 logging.
4697
4698
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004699option dontlognull
4700no option dontlognull
4701 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4703 yes | yes | yes | no
4704 Arguments : none
4705
4706 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4707 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4708 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4709 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4710 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4711 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004712 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4713 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4714 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004715
4716 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4717 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4718 would not be logged.
4719
4720 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4721 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4722
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004723 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4724 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004725
4726
4727option forceclose
4728no option forceclose
4729 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004731 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004732 Arguments : none
4733
4734 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4735 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4736 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4737 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4738 global session times in the logs.
4739
4740 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004741 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004742 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004743
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004744 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4745 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4746 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4747
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004748 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4749 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004750
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004751 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4752 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4753
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004754 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004755
4756
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004757option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004758 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4760 yes | yes | yes | yes
4761 Arguments :
4762 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4763 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004764 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004765 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004766
4767 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4768 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4769 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4770 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4771 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4772 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4773 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004774 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4775 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4776 possible that the client has already brought one.
4777
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004778 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004779 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004780 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4781 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004782 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4783 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004784
4785 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4786 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4787 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4788 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4789 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4790 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4791 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4792
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004793 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4794 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4795 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4796 are under the control of the end-user.
4797
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004798 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004799 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4800 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004801 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4802 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4803 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004804
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004805 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004806 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4807 frontend www
4808 mode http
4809 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4810
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004811 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4812 backend www
4813 mode http
4814 option forwardfor header X-Client
4815
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004816 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004817 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004818
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004819
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004820option http-buffer-request
4821no option http-buffer-request
4822 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
4823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4824 yes | yes | yes | yes
4825 Arguments : none
4826
4827 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
4828 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
4829 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
4830 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
4831 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
4832 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
4833 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
4834 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
4835 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
4836 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
4837 default.
4838
4839 See also : "option http-no-delay"
4840
4841
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004842option http-ignore-probes
4843no option http-ignore-probes
4844 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4846 yes | yes | yes | no
4847 Arguments : none
4848
4849 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4850 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4851 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4852 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4853 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4854 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4855 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4856 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4857 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4858 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4859 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4860 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4861
4862 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4863 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4864 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4865 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4866 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4867 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4868 are often the only way to detect them.
4869
4870 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4871 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4872
4873 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4874
4875
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004876option http-keep-alive
4877no option http-keep-alive
4878 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4880 yes | yes | yes | yes
4881 Arguments : none
4882
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004883 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4884 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4885 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4886 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4887 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4888 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4889 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4890
4891 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4892 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004893 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4894 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4895 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4896 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4897 situations where this option may be useful :
4898
4899 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4900 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4901
4902 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4903 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4904
4905 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4906 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4907 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4908 request.
4909
4910 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4911 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004912 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4913 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4914 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004915
4916 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4917 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4918
4919 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4920 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4921 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4922 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4923 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4924 not set.
4925
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004926 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4927 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004928 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004929 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004930
4931 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004932 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4933 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004934
4935
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004936option http-no-delay
4937no option http-no-delay
4938 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4940 yes | yes | yes | yes
4941 Arguments : none
4942
4943 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4944 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4945 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4946 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4947 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4948 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4949 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4950 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4951 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4952 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4953 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4954 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4955 affected.
4956
4957 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4958 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4959 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4960 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4961 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4962 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4963 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4964 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4965 latency environments.
4966
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004967 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
4968
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004969
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004970option http-pretend-keepalive
4971no option http-pretend-keepalive
4972 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4974 yes | yes | yes | yes
4975 Arguments : none
4976
4977 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4978 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4979 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4980 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4981 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4982 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4983 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4984 consider the response complete.
4985
4986 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4987 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4988 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4989 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4990 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4991 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4992
4993 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4994 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4995 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4996 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4997 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4998 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4999 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5000
5001 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5002 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005003 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005004 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5005 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005006
5007 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5008 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5009
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005010 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5011 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005012
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005013
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005014option http-server-close
5015no option http-server-close
5016 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5018 yes | yes | yes | yes
5019 Arguments : none
5020
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005021 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5022 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5023 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5024 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5025 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5026 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5027 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5028 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5029 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5030 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5031 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5032 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5033 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5034 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5035 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5036 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005037
5038 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5039 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5040 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5041 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005042 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5043 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005044
5045 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5046 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005047 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5048 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005049 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5050 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005051
5052 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5053 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5054
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005055 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005056 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5057 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005058
5059
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005060option http-tunnel
5061no option http-tunnel
5062 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5064 yes | yes | yes | yes
5065 Arguments : none
5066
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005067 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5068 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5069 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5070 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5071 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5072 "option http-tunnel".
5073
5074 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005075 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005076 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5077 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5078 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5079 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5080 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5081 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5082 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005083
5084 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5085 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5086
5087 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5088 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5089 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5090
5091
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005092option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005093no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005094 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 yes | yes | yes | no
5097 Arguments : none
5098
5099 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5100 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5101 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5102 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5103 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5104 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5105 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5106
5107 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5108 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
5109 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
5110 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
5111 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
5112 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
5113 request along its whole life.
5114
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005115 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5116 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5117 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5118 front of an existing proxy.
5119
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005120 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5121
5122 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5123 http-server-close".
5124
5125
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005126option httpchk
5127option httpchk <uri>
5128option httpchk <method> <uri>
5129option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5130 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5132 yes | no | yes | yes
5133 Arguments :
5134 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5135 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5136 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5137 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5138 ones.
5139
5140 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5141 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5142 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5143
5144 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5145 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5146 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5147 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5148 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5149
5150 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5151 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5152 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5153 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5154 the lack of any response.
5155
5156 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5157
5158 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5159 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5160 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5161
5162 Examples :
5163 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5164 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5165 backend https_relay
5166 mode tcp
5167 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5168 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5169
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005170 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5171 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5172 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005173
5174
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005175option httpclose
5176no option httpclose
5177 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5179 yes | yes | yes | yes
5180 Arguments : none
5181
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005182 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5183 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5184 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5185 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005186 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005187 "option http-tunnel".
5188
5189 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5190 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5191 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5192 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5193 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5194 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5195 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5196 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005197
5198 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005199 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005200 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5201 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5202 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5203 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5204 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005205
5206 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5207 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005208 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5209 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005210 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5211 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005212
5213 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5214 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5215
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005216 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5217 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005218
5219
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005220option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005221 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5223 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005224 Arguments :
5225 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5226 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5227 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5228 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5229 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005230
5231 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5232 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5233 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5234 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5235 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5236 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5237 ports.
5238
5239 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5240
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005241 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5242 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005244 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005245
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005246
5247option http_proxy
5248no option http_proxy
5249 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5251 yes | yes | yes | yes
5252 Arguments : none
5253
5254 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5255 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5256 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5257 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5258 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5259
5260 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5261 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
5262 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
5263 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01005264 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005265 be analyzed.
5266
5267 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5268 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5269
5270 Example :
5271 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5272 backend direct_forward
5273 option httpclose
5274 option http_proxy
5275
5276 See also : "option httpclose"
5277
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005278
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005279option independent-streams
5280no option independent-streams
5281 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 yes | yes | yes | yes
5284 Arguments : none
5285
5286 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5287 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5288 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5289 receive data or not.
5290
5291 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5292 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5293 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5294 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5295 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5296 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5297 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5298 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5299 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5300 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5301 socket buffers.
5302
5303 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5304 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5305 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5306 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5307 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5308
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005309 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005310 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5311 deprecated.
5312
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005313 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005314
5315
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005316option ldap-check
5317 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5319 yes | no | yes | yes
5320 Arguments : none
5321
5322 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5323 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5324 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5325 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5326
5327 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5328 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5329
5330 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5331 configure it.
5332
5333 Example :
5334 option ldap-check
5335
5336 See also : "option httpchk"
5337
5338
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005339option external-check
5340 Use external processes for server health checks
5341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5342 yes | no | yes | yes
5343
5344 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5345 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5346 command".
5347
5348 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5349
5350 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5351
5352
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005353option log-health-checks
5354no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005355 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5357 yes | no | yes | yes
5358 Arguments : none
5359
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005360 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5361 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5362 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005363
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005364 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5365 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5366 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5367 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5368 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5369
5370 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5371 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005372
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005373 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5374 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5375 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005376
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005377
5378option log-separate-errors
5379no option log-separate-errors
5380 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5382 yes | yes | yes | no
5383 Arguments : none
5384
5385 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5386 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5387 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5388 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5389 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5390 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5391 provides very important information.
5392
5393 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5394 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5395 error logs.
5396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005397 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005398 logging.
5399
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005400
5401option logasap
5402no option logasap
5403 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5405 yes | yes | yes | no
5406 Arguments : none
5407
5408 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5409 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5410 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5411 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5412 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5413 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5414 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005415 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005416 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5417 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5418
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005419 Examples :
5420 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5421 mode http
5422 option httplog
5423 option logasap
5424 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5425
5426 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5427 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5428 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5429 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005431 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005432 logging.
5433
5434
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005435option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005436 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5438 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005439 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005440 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5441 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005442 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005443
5444 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5445 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5446 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5447 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5448 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5449 in the MySQL table, like this :
5450
5451 USE mysql;
5452 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5453 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5454
5455 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5456 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5457 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5458 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5459 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5460 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5461 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5462 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5463 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5464
5465 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5466 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005467
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005468 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005469
5470 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5471 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5472 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5473 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5474 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5475 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5476
5477 See also: "option httpchk"
5478
5479
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005480option nolinger
5481no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005482 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005483 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5484 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005485 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005486
5487 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5488 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5489 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5490 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5491 connections.
5492
5493 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5494 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5495 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5496 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5497 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5498 this too.
5499
5500 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5501 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5502 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5503
5504 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5505 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5506 for servers.
5507
5508 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5509 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5510
5511
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005512option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5513 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5515 yes | yes | yes | yes
5516 Arguments :
5517 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5518 matching <network>
5519 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5520 header name.
5521
5522 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5523 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5524 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5525 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5526 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5527 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5528 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5529 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5530 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5531 possible that the client has already brought one.
5532
5533 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5534 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5535 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5536 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5537 header and requires different one.
5538
5539 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5540 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5541 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5542 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5543 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5544 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5545 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5546
5547 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5548 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5549 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5550 both are defined.
5551
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005552 Examples :
5553 # Original Destination address
5554 frontend www
5555 mode http
5556 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5557
5558 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5559 backend www
5560 mode http
5561 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5562
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005563 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5564 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005565
5566
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005567option persist
5568no option persist
5569 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5570 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5571 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005572 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005573
5574 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5575 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5576 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5577 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5578 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5579 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5580 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5581 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5582 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5583 redirected to another valid server.
5584
5585 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5586 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5587
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005588 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005589
5590
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005591option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5592 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5594 yes | no | yes | yes
5595 Arguments :
5596 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5597 PostgreSQL server.
5598
5599 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5600 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5601 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5602 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5603
5604 See also: "option httpchk"
5605
5606
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005607option prefer-last-server
5608no option prefer-last-server
5609 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5610 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5611 yes | no | yes | yes
5612 Arguments : none
5613
5614 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5615 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5616 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5617 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5618 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5619 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5620 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5621 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5622 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005623 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5624 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5625 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5626 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5627 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5628 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5629 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005630
5631 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5632 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5633
5634 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5635
5636
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005637option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005638option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005639no option redispatch
5640 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5641 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5642 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005643 Arguments :
5644 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5645 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5646 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5647 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5648 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5649 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5650 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5651 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5652 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5653
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005654
5655 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5656 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5657 be able to access the service anymore.
5658
5659 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5660 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5661
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005662 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005663 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5664 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005666 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5667 "redisp" keywords.
5668
5669 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5670 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5671
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005672 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005673
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005674
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005675option redis-check
5676 Use redis health checks for server testing
5677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5678 yes | no | yes | yes
5679 Arguments : none
5680
5681 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5682 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5683 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5684 find the "+PONG" response message.
5685
5686 Example :
5687 option redis-check
5688
5689 See also : "option httpchk"
5690
5691
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005692option smtpchk
5693option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5694 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5696 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005697 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005698 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5699 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5700 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5701
5702 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5703 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5704 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5705
5706 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5707 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5708 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5709 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5710 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5711 dead server.
5712
5713 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5714 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5715 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5716 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5717
5718 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5719 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5720 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5721 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5722 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5723
5724 Example :
5725 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5726
5727 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5728
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005730option socket-stats
5731no option socket-stats
5732
5733 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5735 yes | yes | yes | no
5736
5737 Arguments : none
5738
5739
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005740option splice-auto
5741no option splice-auto
5742 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5744 yes | yes | yes | yes
5745 Arguments : none
5746
5747 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5748 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5749 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5750 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005751 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005752 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5753 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5754 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5755 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5756
5757 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5758 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5759 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5760 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5761 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5762 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5763 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5764 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5765 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5766 keyword.
5767
5768 Example :
5769 option splice-auto
5770
5771 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5772 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5773
5774 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5775 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5776
5777
5778option splice-request
5779no option splice-request
5780 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5782 yes | yes | yes | yes
5783 Arguments : none
5784
5785 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005786 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005787 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5788 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5789 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5790 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5791
5792 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5793
5794 Example :
5795 option splice-request
5796
5797 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5798 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5799
5800 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5801 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5802
5803
5804option splice-response
5805no option splice-response
5806 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5808 yes | yes | yes | yes
5809 Arguments : none
5810
5811 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005812 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005813 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5814 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5815 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5816 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5817
5818 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5819
5820 Example :
5821 option splice-response
5822
5823 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5824 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5825
5826 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5827 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5828
5829
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005830option srvtcpka
5831no option srvtcpka
5832 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5834 yes | no | yes | yes
5835 Arguments : none
5836
5837 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5838 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5839 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5840 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5841
5842 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5843 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5844 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5845 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5846
5847 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5848 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5849 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5850 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5851 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5852
5853 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5854
5855 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5856 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5857 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5858
5859 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5860 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5861
5862 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5863
5864
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005865option ssl-hello-chk
5866 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5868 yes | no | yes | yes
5869 Arguments : none
5870
5871 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5872 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5873 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5874 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5875 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5876 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5877 hello message.
5878
5879 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5880 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5881 messages, which is appreciable.
5882
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005883 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5884 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5885 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005886
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005887 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5888
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005889
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005890option tcp-check
5891 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5892 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5893 yes | no | yes | yes
5894
5895 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5896 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5897
5898 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5899 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5900 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5901
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005902 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005903 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5904 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5905 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5906 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5907 only.
5908
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005909 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005910 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5911 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5912 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5913 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5914
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005915 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005916 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5917 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005918 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005919 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5920 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5921 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5922 the respective protocols.
5923 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5924 analysed.
5925
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005926 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
5927 script.
5928
5929 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
5930 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
5931 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
5932 The "comment" is of course optional.
5933
5934
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005935 Examples :
5936 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5937 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005938 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005939
5940 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5941 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005942 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005943
5944 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5945 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005946 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005947 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005948 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005949 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02005950 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005951 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005952 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5953 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005954 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005955 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5956 tcp-check expect string +OK
5957
5958 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5959 (send many headers before analyzing)
5960 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005961 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005962 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5963 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5964 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5965 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005966 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005967
5968
5969 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5970
5971
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005972option tcp-smart-accept
5973no option tcp-smart-accept
5974 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5976 yes | yes | yes | no
5977 Arguments : none
5978
5979 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5980 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5981 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5982 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5983 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5984 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5985
5986 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5987 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5988 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5989 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5990
5991 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5992 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5993 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5994 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5995
5996 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5997 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5998 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5999
6000 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6001 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6002 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6003
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006004 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6005
6006
6007option tcp-smart-connect
6008no option tcp-smart-connect
6009 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6011 yes | no | yes | yes
6012 Arguments : none
6013
6014 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6015 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6016 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6017 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6018 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6019
6020 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6021 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6022 complex.
6023
6024 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6025 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6026 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6027
6028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6030
6031 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6032
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006033
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006034option tcpka
6035 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6037 yes | yes | yes | yes
6038 Arguments : none
6039
6040 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6041 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6042 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6043 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6044
6045 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6046 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6047 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6048 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6049
6050 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6051 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6052 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6053 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6054 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6055
6056 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6057
6058 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6059 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6060 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6061 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6062 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6063 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6064 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6065 backends.
6066
6067 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6068
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006069
6070option tcplog
6071 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6073 yes | yes | yes | yes
6074 Arguments : none
6075
6076 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6077 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6078 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6079 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6080 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6081 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6082 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6083 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6084
6085 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006087 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006088
6089
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006090option transparent
6091no option transparent
6092 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006094 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006095 Arguments : none
6096
6097 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6098 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6099 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6100 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6101 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6102 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6103 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6104 appropriate server.
6105
6106 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6107 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6108
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006109 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006110 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006111
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006112
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006113external-check command <command>
6114 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6116 yes | no | yes | yes
6117
6118 Arguments :
6119 <command> is the external command to run
6120
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006121 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6122
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006123 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006124
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006125 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6126 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6127 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6128 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6129 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6130 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006131
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006132 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6133
6134 Environment variables :
6135 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6136 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6137
6138 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6139
6140 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6141
6142 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6143 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6144 for a UNIX socket).
6145
6146 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6147
6148 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6149
6150 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6151
6152 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6153
6154 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6155
6156 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6157 socket).
6158
6159 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6160 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6161
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006162 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6163 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6164 failed.
6165
6166 Example :
6167 external-check command /bin/true
6168
6169 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6170
6171
6172external-check path <path>
6173 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6175 yes | no | yes | yes
6176
6177 Arguments :
6178 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6179
6180 The default path is "".
6181
6182 Example :
6183 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6184
6185 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6186 "external-check command"
6187
6188
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006189persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006190persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006191 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6193 yes | no | yes | yes
6194 Arguments :
6195 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006196 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6197 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006198
6199 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6200 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6201 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6202 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6203 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6204 forwarded to this server.
6205
6206 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6207 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6208 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006209 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006210 a single "listen" section.
6211
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006212 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6213 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6214 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6215
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006216 Example :
6217 listen tse-farm
6218 bind :3389
6219 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6220 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6221 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6222 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6223 persist rdp-cookie
6224 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006225 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006226 balance rdp-cookie
6227 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6228 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6229
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006230 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6231 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006232
6233
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006234rate-limit sessions <rate>
6235 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6237 yes | yes | yes | no
6238 Arguments :
6239 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6240 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6241
6242 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6243 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6244 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6245 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6246 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6247 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6248
6249 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6250 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6251 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6252 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6253
6254 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6255 listen smtp
6256 mode tcp
6257 bind :25
6258 rate-limit sessions 10
6259 server 127.0.0.1:1025
6260
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006261 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6262 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6263 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006264
6265 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6266
6267
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006268redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6269redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6270redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006271 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6273 no | yes | yes | yes
6274
6275 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006276 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006277
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006278 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006279 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006280 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6281 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6282 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006283
6284 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6285 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6286 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6287 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6288 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006289 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6290 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6291 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6292 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006293
6294 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6295 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6296 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6297 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6298 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6299 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006300 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006301 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006302 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6303 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6304 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006305
6306 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006307 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6308 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6309 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006310 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006311 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6312 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6313 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6314 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006315
6316 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6317 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6318
6319 - "drop-query"
6320 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6321 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6322 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6323 with a location-type redirect.
6324
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006325 - "append-slash"
6326 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6327 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6328 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6329 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6330
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006331 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6332 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6333 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6334 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6335 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6336 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6337 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6338
6339 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6340 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6341 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6342 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6343 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6344 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6345 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006346
6347 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6348 acl clear dst_port 80
6349 acl secure dst_port 8080
6350 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006351 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006352 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006353 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6354
6355 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006356 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6357 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6358 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006359 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006360
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006361 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6362 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6363 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6364
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006365 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006366 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006367
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006368 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6369 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6370 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006372 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006373
6374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006375redisp (deprecated)
6376redispatch (deprecated)
6377 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6378 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6379 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006380 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006381
6382 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6383 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6384 be able to access the service anymore.
6385
6386 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6387 redistribute them to a working server.
6388
6389 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6390 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6391 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006392
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006393 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6394 "option redispatch" instead.
6395
6396 See also : "option redispatch"
6397
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006398
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006399reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006400 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6402 no | yes | yes | yes
6403 Arguments :
6404 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6405 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006406 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006407
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006408 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6409 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6410
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006411 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6412 the last header of an HTTP request.
6413
6414 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6415 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6416 responses.
6417
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006418 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6419 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6420 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6421
6422 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6423 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006424
6425
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006426reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6427reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006428 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6430 no | yes | yes | yes
6431 Arguments :
6432 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6433 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6434 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6435 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6436 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6437 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6438 ignores case.
6439
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006440 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6441 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6442
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006443 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6444 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6445 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6446 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006447 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006448
6449 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6450 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6451
6452 Example :
6453 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6454 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6455 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6456
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006457 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6458 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006459
6460
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006461reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6462reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006463 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6465 no | yes | yes | yes
6466 Arguments :
6467 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6468 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6469 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6470 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6471 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6472 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6473
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006474 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6475 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6476
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006477 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6478 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6479 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6480 next servers.
6481
6482 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6483 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6484 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6485
6486 Example :
6487 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6488 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6489 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6490
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006491 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6492 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006493
6494
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006495reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6496reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006497 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6499 no | yes | yes | yes
6500 Arguments :
6501 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6502 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6503 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6504 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6505 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6506 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6507 case.
6508
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006509 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6510 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6511
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006512 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6513 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6514 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6515 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006516 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006517
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006518 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006519 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006520 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006521
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006522 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6523 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6524
6525 Example :
6526 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6527 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6528 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6529
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006530 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6531 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006532
6533
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006534reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6535reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006536 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6538 no | yes | yes | yes
6539 Arguments :
6540 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6541 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6542 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6543 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6544 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6545 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6546 case.
6547
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006548 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6549 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6550
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006551 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6552 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6553 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6554 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6555
6556 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6557 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6558
6559 Example :
6560 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6561 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6562 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6563 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6564
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006565 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6566 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006567
6568
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006569reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6570reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006571 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6573 no | yes | yes | yes
6574 Arguments :
6575 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6576 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6577 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6578 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6579 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6580 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6581
6582 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6583 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6584 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6585 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006586 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006587
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006588 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6589 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6590
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006591 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6592 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6593 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6594
6595 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6596 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6597 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6598 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6599 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6600
6601 Example :
6602 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006603 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006604 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6605 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6606
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006607 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6608 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006609
6610
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006611reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6612reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006613 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6615 no | yes | yes | yes
6616 Arguments :
6617 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6618 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6619 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6620 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6621 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6622 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6623 ignores case.
6624
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006625 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6626 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6627
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006628 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6629 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006630 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6631 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6632 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006633 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6634 not set.
6635
6636 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6637 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6638 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6639 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6640 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6641
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006642 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006643 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6644 # block all others.
6645 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6646 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6647
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006648 # block bad guys
6649 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6650 reqitarpit . if badguys
6651
6652 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6653 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006654
6655
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006656retries <value>
6657 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6658 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6659 yes | no | yes | yes
6660 Arguments :
6661 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6662 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6663 default value is 3.
6664
6665 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6666 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6667 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6668
6669 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006670 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6671 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006672
6673 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6674 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6675
6676 See also : "option redispatch"
6677
6678
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006679rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006680 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6682 no | yes | yes | yes
6683 Arguments :
6684 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6685 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006686 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006687
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006688 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6689 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6690
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006691 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6692 the last header of an HTTP response.
6693
6694 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6695 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6696 responses.
6697
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006698 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6699 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006700
6701
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006702rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6703rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006704 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6706 no | yes | yes | yes
6707 Arguments :
6708 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6709 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6710 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6711 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6712 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6713 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6714 ignores case.
6715
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006716 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6717 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6718
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006719 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6720 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006721 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006722 client.
6723
6724 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6725 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6726 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6727
6728 Example :
6729 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006730 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006731
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006732 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6733 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006734
6735
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006736rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6737rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006738 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6740 no | yes | yes | yes
6741 Arguments :
6742 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6743 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6744 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6745 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6746 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6747 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6748 ignores case.
6749
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006750 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6751 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6752
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006753 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6754 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6755 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6756 case-sensitive.
6757
6758 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006759 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6760 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6761 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006762
6763 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6764 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6765
6766 Example :
6767 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6768 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6769
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006770 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6771 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006772
6773
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006774rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6775rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006776 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6778 no | yes | yes | yes
6779 Arguments :
6780 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6781 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6782 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6783 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6784 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6785 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6786 ignores case.
6787
6788 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6789 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6790 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6791 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006792 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006793
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006794 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6795 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6796
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006797 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6798 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6799 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6800
6801 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6802 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6803 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6804 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6805 are not case-sensitive.
6806
6807 Example :
6808 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6809 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6810
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006811 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6812 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006813
6814
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006815server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006816 Declare a server in a backend
6817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6818 no | no | yes | yes
6819 Arguments :
6820 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006821 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006822 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006823
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006824 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6825 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6826 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6827 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006828 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6829 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6830 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6831 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6832 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006833 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6834 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6835 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6836 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6837 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6838 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6839 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006840 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006841 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6842 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
6843 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006844
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006845 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006846 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6847 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6848 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6849 adding this value to the client's port.
6850
6851 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6852 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006853 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006854
6855 Examples :
6856 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6857 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006858 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006859 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
6860 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
6861 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006862
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006863 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6864 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006865
6866
6867source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006868source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006869source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006870 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6872 yes | no | yes | yes
6873 Arguments :
6874 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6875 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006876
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006877 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006878 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6879 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6880 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6881 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6882 supported prefixes are :
6883 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6884 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6885 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006886 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006887 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
6888 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006889
6890 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6891 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006892 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6893 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6894 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006895
6896 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6897 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6898 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6899 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6900 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6901 <addr>.
6902
6903 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6904 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6905 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6906 port.
6907
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006908 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6909 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6910 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6911 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006912 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006913 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6914 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6915 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6916 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6917 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6918 HTTP header.
6919
6920 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6921 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006922 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006923 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6924 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6925 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6926 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6927 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6928 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6929 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6930
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006931 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6932 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6933 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6934 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6935 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6936 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6937
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006938 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6939 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6940 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6941 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6942
6943 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6944 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6945 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6946 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6947 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6948 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6949
6950 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6951 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6952 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6953 there are two methods :
6954
6955 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6956 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6957 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6958 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6959 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6960 of the client ranges may be used.
6961
6962 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6963 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6964 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6965 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6966 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6967 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6968 same session.
6969
6970 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6971 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6972 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6973 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6974 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6975 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6976
6977 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6978 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6979 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006980 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006981
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02006982 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
6983
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006984 Examples :
6985 backend private
6986 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6987 source 192.168.1.200
6988
6989 backend transparent_ssl1
6990 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6991 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6992
6993 backend transparent_ssl2
6994 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6995 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6996 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6997
6998 backend transparent_ssl3
6999 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7000 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7001 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7002
7003 backend transparent_smtp
7004 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7005 # with Tproxy version 4.
7006 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7007
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007008 backend transparent_http
7009 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7010 # proxy.
7011 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007013 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007014 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007016
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007017srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7018 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7020 yes | no | yes | yes
7021 Arguments :
7022 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7023 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7024 as explained at the top of this document.
7025
7026 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7027 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7028 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7029 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7030 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7031 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7032 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7033
7034 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7035 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7036 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7037 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7038 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007039 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007040 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007041 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007042
7043 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7044 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7045 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7046 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7047 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7048 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7049
7050 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7051 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7052
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007053 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7054 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007055
7056
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007057stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7058 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007060 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007061
7062 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7063 matched.
7064
7065 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7066 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7067
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007068 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7069 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7070 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7071
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007072 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7073 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7074 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7075 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007076
7077 Example :
7078 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7079 backend stats_localhost
7080 stats enable
7081 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7082
7083 Example :
7084 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7085 backend stats_auth
7086 stats enable
7087 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7088 stats admin if TRUE
7089
7090 Example :
7091 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7092 userlist stats-auth
7093 group admin users admin
7094 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7095 group readonly users haproxy
7096 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7097
7098 backend stats_auth
7099 stats enable
7100 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7101 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7102 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7103 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7104
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007105 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7106 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7107 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007108
7109
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007110stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7111 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007113 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007114 Arguments :
7115 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7116
7117 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7118
7119 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7120 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7121 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7122 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7123 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7124 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7125
7126 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7127 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7128 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007129 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007130
7131 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7132 report using "stats scope".
7133
7134 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7135 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7136 unobvious parameters.
7137
7138 Example :
7139 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7140 backend public_www
7141 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7142 stats enable
7143 stats hide-version
7144 stats scope .
7145 stats uri /admin?stats
7146 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7147 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7148 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7149
7150 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7151 backend private_monitoring
7152 stats enable
7153 stats uri /admin?stats
7154 stats refresh 5s
7155
7156 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7157
7158
7159stats enable
7160 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007162 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007163 Arguments : none
7164
7165 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7166 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7167 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7168 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7169 - stats auth : no authentication
7170 - stats scope : no restriction
7171
7172 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7173 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7174 unobvious parameters.
7175
7176 Example :
7177 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7178 backend public_www
7179 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7180 stats enable
7181 stats hide-version
7182 stats scope .
7183 stats uri /admin?stats
7184 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7185 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7186 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7187
7188 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7189 backend private_monitoring
7190 stats enable
7191 stats uri /admin?stats
7192 stats refresh 5s
7193
7194 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7195
7196
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007197stats hide-version
7198 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007200 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007201 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007202
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007203 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7204 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7205 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7206 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7207 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7208 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007210 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7211 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7212 unobvious parameters.
7213
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007214 Example :
7215 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7216 backend public_www
7217 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007218 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007219 stats hide-version
7220 stats scope .
7221 stats uri /admin?stats
7222 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7223 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7224 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007225
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007226 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7227 backend private_monitoring
7228 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007229 stats uri /admin?stats
7230 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007231
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007232 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007233
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007234
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007235stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7236 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7237 Access control for statistics
7238
7239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7240 no | no | yes | yes
7241
7242 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7243 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7244 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7245 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7246 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7247 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7248
7249 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7250 instance.
7251
7252 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7253 about ACL usage.
7254
7255
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007256stats realm <realm>
7257 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007259 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007260 Arguments :
7261 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7262 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7263 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7264
7265 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7266 using a backslash ('\').
7267
7268 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7269 only related to authentication.
7270
7271 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7272 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7273 unobvious parameters.
7274
7275 Example :
7276 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7277 backend public_www
7278 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7279 stats enable
7280 stats hide-version
7281 stats scope .
7282 stats uri /admin?stats
7283 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7284 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7285 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7286
7287 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7288 backend private_monitoring
7289 stats enable
7290 stats uri /admin?stats
7291 stats refresh 5s
7292
7293 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7294
7295
7296stats refresh <delay>
7297 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007299 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007300 Arguments :
7301 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7302 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7303 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7304 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7305 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7306 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7307
7308 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7309 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7310 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7311 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7312
7313 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7314 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7315 unobvious parameters.
7316
7317 Example :
7318 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7319 backend public_www
7320 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7321 stats enable
7322 stats hide-version
7323 stats scope .
7324 stats uri /admin?stats
7325 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7326 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7327 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7328
7329 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7330 backend private_monitoring
7331 stats enable
7332 stats uri /admin?stats
7333 stats refresh 5s
7334
7335 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7336
7337
7338stats scope { <name> | "." }
7339 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007341 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007342 Arguments :
7343 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7344 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7345 section in which the statement appears.
7346
7347 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7348 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7349 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7350 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7351 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7352 exists.
7353
7354 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7355 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7356 unobvious parameters.
7357
7358 Example :
7359 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7360 backend public_www
7361 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7362 stats enable
7363 stats hide-version
7364 stats scope .
7365 stats uri /admin?stats
7366 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7367 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7368 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7369
7370 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7371 backend private_monitoring
7372 stats enable
7373 stats uri /admin?stats
7374 stats refresh 5s
7375
7376 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7377
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007378
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007379stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007380 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007382 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007383
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007384 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007385 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7386
7387 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7388 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7389
7390 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7391 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007392 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007393
7394 Example :
7395 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7396 backend private_monitoring
7397 stats enable
7398 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7399 stats uri /admin?stats
7400 stats refresh 5s
7401
7402 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7403 global section.
7404
7405
7406stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007407 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7409 yes | yes | yes | yes
7410 Arguments : none
7411
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007412 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007413 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7414 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7415 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7416 - IP (socket, server)
7417 - cookie (backend, server)
7418
7419 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7420 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007421 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007422
7423 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7424
7425
7426stats show-node [ <name> ]
7427 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007429 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007430 Arguments:
7431 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7432 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7433
7434 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7435 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007436 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007437
7438 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7439 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7440 unobvious parameters.
7441
7442 Example:
7443 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7444 backend private_monitoring
7445 stats enable
7446 stats show-node Europe-1
7447 stats uri /admin?stats
7448 stats refresh 5s
7449
7450 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7451 section.
7452
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007453
7454stats uri <prefix>
7455 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007457 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007458 Arguments :
7459 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7460 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7461 query string.
7462
7463 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7464 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7465 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7466 possible to reach it in the application.
7467
7468 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007469 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007470 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7471 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7472 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7473 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7474
7475 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7476 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7477 an address or a port to statistics only.
7478
7479 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7480 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7481 unobvious parameters.
7482
7483 Example :
7484 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7485 backend public_www
7486 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7487 stats enable
7488 stats hide-version
7489 stats scope .
7490 stats uri /admin?stats
7491 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7492 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7493 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7494
7495 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7496 backend private_monitoring
7497 stats enable
7498 stats uri /admin?stats
7499 stats refresh 5s
7500
7501 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7502
7503
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007504stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7505 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007507 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007508
7509 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007510 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007511 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7512 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7513 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7514
7515 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7516 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7517 the "stick-table" statement.
7518
7519 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7520 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7521 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7522 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7523 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7524
7525 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7526 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7527 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7528 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7529 transformation rules.
7530
7531 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7532 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7533 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7534 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7535 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7536 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7537 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7538
7539 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7540 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7541 ACL based conditions.
7542
7543 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7544 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7545 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7546 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7547
7548 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7549 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7550 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7551 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7552
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007553 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7554 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7555 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7556
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007557 Example :
7558 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7559 # last 30 minutes
7560 backend pop
7561 mode tcp
7562 balance roundrobin
7563 stick store-request src
7564 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7565 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7566 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7567
7568 backend smtp
7569 mode tcp
7570 balance roundrobin
7571 stick match src table pop
7572 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7573 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7574
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007575 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007576 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007577
7578
7579stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7580 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7582 no | no | yes | yes
7583
7584 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7585 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7586 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7587 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7588
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007589 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7590 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7591 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7592
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007593 Examples :
7594 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007595 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007596
7597 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7598 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7599 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7600
7601
7602 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7603 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7604 backend http
7605 mode http
7606 balance roundrobin
7607 stick on src table https
7608 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7609 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7610 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7611
7612 backend https
7613 mode tcp
7614 balance roundrobin
7615 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7616 stick on src
7617 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7618 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7619
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007620 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007621
7622
7623stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7624 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7626 no | no | yes | yes
7627
7628 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007629 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007630 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7631 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7632 server is selected.
7633
7634 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7635 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7636 the "stick-table" statement.
7637
7638 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7639 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7640 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7641 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7642 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7643 address.
7644
7645 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7646 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7647 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7648 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7649 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7650 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7651 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7652 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7653 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7654 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7655
7656 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7657 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7658 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7659 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7660 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7661 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7662 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7663
7664 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7665 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7666 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7667 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7668
7669 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7670 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7671 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7672 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7673 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7674 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007675 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7676 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7677 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7678 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7679 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7680 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007681
7682 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7683 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7684 the request.
7685
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007686 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7687 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7688 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7689
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007690 Example :
7691 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7692 # last 30 minutes
7693 backend pop
7694 mode tcp
7695 balance roundrobin
7696 stick store-request src
7697 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7698 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7699 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7700
7701 backend smtp
7702 mode tcp
7703 balance roundrobin
7704 stick match src table pop
7705 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7706 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7707
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007708 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007709 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007710
7711
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007712stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007713 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7714 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007715 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007717 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007718
7719 Arguments :
7720 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7721 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7722 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7723 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7724
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007725 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7726 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7727 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7728 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7729
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007730 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7731 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7732 instance.
7733
7734 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7735 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7736 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7737 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7738 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7739 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007740 to 32 characters.
7741
7742 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7743 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7744 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007745 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007746 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7747 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007748
7749 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007750 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7751 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007752 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7753 increase.
7754
7755 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007756 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7757 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7758 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007759
7760 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7761 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7762 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7763 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7764 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7765 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7766 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7767 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7768 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7769 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7770 parameter (see below).
7771
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007772 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7773 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7774 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7775 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7776 soft restart.
7777
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007778 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7779 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007780
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007781 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7782 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7783 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7784 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7785 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007786 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007787 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7788 if not expiration delay is specified.
7789
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007790 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7791 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7792 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7793 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007794 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7795 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7796 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7797 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7798 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7799 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7800 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7801 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7802 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7803 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7804 types and their arguments.
7805
7806 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7807 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7808 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7809 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7810
7811 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7812 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7813 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7814 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7815
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007816 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7817 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7818 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7819 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7820 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7821 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7822
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007823 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7824 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7825 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7826 they were received.
7827
7828 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7829 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7830 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7831 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7832 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7833
7834 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7835 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7836 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7837 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7838 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7839
7840 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7841 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7842 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7843
7844 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7845 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7846 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7847 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7848 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7849
7850 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7851 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7852 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7853 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7854 the client side.
7855
7856 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7857 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7858 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7859 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7860 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7861 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7862 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7863
7864 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7865 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7866 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7867 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7868 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7869 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7870 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7871
7872 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7873 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7874 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7875 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7876 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7877 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7878
7879 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7880 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7881 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7882 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7883
7884 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7885 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7886 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7887 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7888 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7889 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7890 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7891 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7892 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7893 recommended for better fairness.
7894
7895 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7896 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7897 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7898 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7899
7900 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7901 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7902 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7903 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7904 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7905 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7906 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7907 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7908 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7909 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007910
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007911 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7912 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007913 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7914 reference it.
7915
7916 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7917 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7918 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7919 as an exclusive stickiness.
7920
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007921 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7922 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7923 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7924 something that can be ignored.
7925
7926 Example:
7927 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7928 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7929 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7930 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7931
7932 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007933 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007934
7935
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007936stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7937 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7939 no | no | yes | yes
7940
7941 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007942 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007943 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7944 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7945 server is selected.
7946
7947 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7948 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7949 the "stick-table" statement.
7950
7951 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7952 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7953 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7954 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7955
7956 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7957 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7958 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7959 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7960 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7961 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007962 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007963 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7964 rules.
7965
7966 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7967 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7968 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7969 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7970 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7971 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7972 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7973
7974 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7975 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7976 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7977 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7978
7979 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7980 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7981 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7982 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7983 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7984 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007985 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7986 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7987 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7988 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7989 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7990 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7991 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7992 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7993 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007994
7995 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7996
7997 Example :
7998 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7999 backend https
8000 mode tcp
8001 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008002 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008003 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008004
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008005 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8006 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8007
8008 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8009 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8010 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8011
8012 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8013 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008014
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008015 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8016 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8017 # at offset 44.
8018
8019 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8020 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8021
8022 # Learn on response if server hello.
8023 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008024
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008025 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8026 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8027
8028 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8029 extraction.
8030
8031
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008032tcp-check connect [params*]
8033 Opens a new connection
8034 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8035 no | no | yes | yes
8036
8037 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8038 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8039 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8040
8041 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8042 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8043 of the sequence.
8044
8045 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8046 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8047 do.
8048
8049 Parameters :
8050 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8051 use the TCP connection.
8052
8053 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8054 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8055 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8056
8057 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8058
8059 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8060
8061 Examples:
8062 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8063 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8064 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8065 option tcp-check
8066 tcp-check connect
8067 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8068 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8069 tcp-check send \r\n
8070 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8071 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8072 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8073 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8074 tcp-check send \r\n
8075 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8076 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8077
8078 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8079 option tcp-check
8080 tcp-check connect port 110
8081 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8082 tcp-check connect port 143
8083 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8084 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8085
8086 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8087
8088
8089tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8090 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8091 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8092 no | no | yes | yes
8093
8094 Arguments :
8095 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8096 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8097 binary.
8098 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8099 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8100 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8101
8102 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8103 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8104 with the usual backslash ('\').
8105 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8106 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8107 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8108 used upper or lower case.
8109
8110
8111 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8112
8113 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8114 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8115 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8116 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8117 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8118 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8119 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8120 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8121
8122 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8123 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8124 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8125 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8126 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8127 expression.
8128
8129 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8130 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8131 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8132 this exact hexadecimal string.
8133 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8134
8135 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8136 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8137 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8138 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8139 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8140 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8141 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8142 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8143 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8144 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8145 the null character.
8146
8147 Examples :
8148 # perform a POP check
8149 option tcp-check
8150 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8151
8152 # perform an IMAP check
8153 option tcp-check
8154 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8155
8156 # look for the redis master server
8157 option tcp-check
8158 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008159 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008160 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8161 tcp-check expect string role:master
8162 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8163 tcp-check expect string +OK
8164
8165
8166 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8167 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8168
8169
8170tcp-check send <data>
8171 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8172 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8173 no | no | yes | yes
8174
8175 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8176 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8177
8178 Examples :
8179 # look for the redis master server
8180 option tcp-check
8181 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8182 tcp-check expect string role:master
8183
8184 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8185 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8186
8187
8188tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8189 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8190 tcp health check
8191 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8192 no | no | yes | yes
8193
8194 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8195 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8196 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8197 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8198 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8199 hexadecimal string.
8200 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8201
8202 Examples :
8203 # redis check in binary
8204 option tcp-check
8205 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8206 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8207
8208
8209 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8210 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8211
8212
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008213tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8214 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8216 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008217 Arguments :
8218 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008219 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
8220 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008221
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008222 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008223
8224 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8225 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008226 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8227 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8228 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8229 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8230 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8231 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008232
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008233 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8234 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8235 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8236 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008237
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008238 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008239 - accept :
8240 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8241 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8242 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008244 - reject :
8245 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8246 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8247 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8248 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8249 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8250 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8251 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8252 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8253 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8254 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8255 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8256 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008257
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008258 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8259 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8260 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8261 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8262 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8263 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8264 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8265 hosts.
8266
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008267 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8268 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8269 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8270 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8271 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8272 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8273 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8274 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8275 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008276 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8277 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008278
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008279 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008280 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008281 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008282 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008283 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8284 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008285 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008286 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8287 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8288 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8289 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8290 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008292 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008293 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008294 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008295 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8296 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8297 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8298 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008299
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008300 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8301 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8302 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8303 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008304
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008305 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8306 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8307 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8308 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8309 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008310 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8311 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8312 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8313 layer7 information is extracted.
8314
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008315 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8316 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8317 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8318 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8319 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008320
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008321 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8322 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8323 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008325 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8326 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8327 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008328
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008329 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008330 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008331 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008332
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008333 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8334 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8335 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008336
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008337 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008338 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8339 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008340
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008341 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8342
8343 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8344
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008345 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8346
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008347 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008348
8349
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008350tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8351 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008353 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008354 Arguments :
8355 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008356 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008357 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
8358 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008359
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008360 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008361
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008362 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8363 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8364 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8365 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8366 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008367
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008368 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8369 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8370 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8371 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008372 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8373 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8374 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8375 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8376 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8377 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008378 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008379 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008380
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008381 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8382 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8383 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8384 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008385
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008386 Four types of actions are supported :
8387 - accept : the request is accepted
8388 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8389 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008390 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008391 - lua <function>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008392 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008393
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008394 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8395 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008396
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008397 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8398 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8399 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8400 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8401 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8402 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008404 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008405 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8406 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008407
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008408 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008409 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8410 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8411 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8412 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008413 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8414 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8415 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008416
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008417 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008418 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8419 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8420 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008421
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008422 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8423 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8424 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8425 documentation.
8426
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008427 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8428 declared inline.
8429
8430 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8431 The allowed scopes are:
8432 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8433 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8434 (request and response)
8435 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8436 processing
8437 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8438 processing.
8439 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8440 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8441
8442 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8443 followed by some converters.
8444
8445 Example:
8446
8447 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8448
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008449 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008450 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8451 # and reject everything else.
8452 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8453 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008454 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008455 tcp-request content reject
8456
8457 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008458 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8459 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8460 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008461 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008462
8463 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8464 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8465 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008466 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008467 tcp-request content reject
8468
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008469 Example:
8470 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8471 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008472 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008473
8474 Example:
8475 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8476 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008477 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008478
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008479 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8480 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8481
8482 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008483 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008484 # protecting all our sites
8485 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008486 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8487 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008488 ...
8489 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8490
8491 backend http_dynamic
8492 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008493 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008494 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008495 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8496 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8497 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008498 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008500 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008501
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008502 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008503
8504
8505tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8506 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008508 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008509 Arguments :
8510 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8511 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8512 as explained at the top of this document.
8513
8514 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8515 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8516 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8517 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8518 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8519
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008520 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8521 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8522 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8523 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8524
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008525 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8526 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008527 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008528 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008529 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8530 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8531 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8532 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008533
8534 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8535 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8536 it pass through unaffected.
8537
8538 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8539 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8540 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008541 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008542 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8543 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008544 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8545 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8546 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008547
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008548 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008549 "timeout client".
8550
8551
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008552tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8553 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8555 no | no | yes | yes
8556 Arguments :
8557 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008558 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008559
8560 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8561
8562 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8563 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8564 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008565 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8566 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008567
8568 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8569
8570 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8571 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8572 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8573 inserted.
8574
8575 Two types of actions are supported :
8576 - accept :
8577 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8578 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8579 the rules evaluation.
8580
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008581 - close :
8582 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8583 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8584 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8585 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8586 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8587 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008588 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008589 protocols.
8590
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008591 - reject :
8592 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8593 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008594 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008595
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008596 - lua <function>
8597 Executes Lua.
8598
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008599 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
8600 Sets a variable.
8601
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008602 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8603 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8604 for changing the default action to a reject.
8605
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008606 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8607 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8608 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8609 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008610 period.
8611
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008612 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8613 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8614 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8615 documentation.
8616
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008617 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8618 declared inline.
8619
8620 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8621 The allowed scopes are:
8622 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8623 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8624 (request and response)
8625 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8626 processing
8627 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8628 processing.
8629 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8630 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8631
8632 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8633 followed by some converters.
8634
8635 Example:
8636
8637 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8638
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008639 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8640
8641 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8642
8643
8644tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8645 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8647 no | no | yes | yes
8648 Arguments :
8649 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8650 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8651 as explained at the top of this document.
8652
8653 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8654
8655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008656timeout check <timeout>
8657 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8658 established.
8659
8660 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8661 yes | no | yes | yes
8662 Arguments:
8663 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8664 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8665 as explained at the top of this document.
8666
8667 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8668 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8669 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8670 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008671 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8672 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8673 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008674
8675 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8676 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8677
8678 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8679 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008680 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008681
8682 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8683 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8684 forget about it.
8685
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008686 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8687 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008688
8689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008690timeout client <timeout>
8691timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8692 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8694 yes | yes | yes | no
8695 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008696 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008697 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8698 as explained at the top of this document.
8699
8700 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8701 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8702 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8703 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8704 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8705 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8706 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8707 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008708 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008709 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008710 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8711 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008712 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8713 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008714
8715 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8716 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8717 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8718 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8719 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8720 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8721
8722 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8723 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8724 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8725
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008726 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008727
8728
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008729timeout client-fin <timeout>
8730 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8732 yes | yes | yes | no
8733 Arguments :
8734 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8735 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8736 as explained at the top of this document.
8737
8738 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8739 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8740 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8741 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8742 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8743 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8744 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8745 down in one direction.
8746
8747 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8748 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8749 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8750
8751 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8752
8753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008754timeout connect <timeout>
8755timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8756 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8758 yes | no | yes | yes
8759 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008760 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008761 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8762 as explained at the top of this document.
8763
8764 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008765 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008766 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008767 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008768 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8769 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008770
8771 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8772 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8773 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8774 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8775 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8776 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8777
8778 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8779 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8780 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8781
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008782 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8783 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008784
8785
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008786timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8787 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8789 yes | yes | yes | yes
8790 Arguments :
8791 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8792 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8793 as explained at the top of this document.
8794
8795 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8796 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8797 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8798 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8799 once the request has started to present itself.
8800
8801 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8802 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8803 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8804 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8805 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8806
8807 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8808 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8809 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8810 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8811
8812 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8813 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8814 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8815 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8816 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008817 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008818
8819 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8820 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8821 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8822 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8823
8824 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8825
8826
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008827timeout http-request <timeout>
8828 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008830 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008831 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008832 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008833 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8834 as explained at the top of this document.
8835
8836 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8837 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8838 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8839 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8840 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8841 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8842 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008843 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8844 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8845 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8846 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8847 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008848 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8849 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008850
8851 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8852 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008853 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8854 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008855
8856 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8857 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8858 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8859 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8860 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8861
8862 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008863 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8864 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8865 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008866
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008867 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8868 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008869
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008870
8871timeout queue <timeout>
8872 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8874 yes | no | yes | yes
8875 Arguments :
8876 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8877 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8878 as explained at the top of this document.
8879
8880 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8881 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8882 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8883 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8884 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8885
8886 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8887 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8888 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8889 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8890
8891 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8892
8893
8894timeout server <timeout>
8895timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8896 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8898 yes | no | yes | yes
8899 Arguments :
8900 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8901 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8902 as explained at the top of this document.
8903
8904 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8905 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8906 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8907 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8908 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8909 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8910 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8911
8912 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8913 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8914 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8915 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8916 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008917 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008918 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008919 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8920 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8921 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8922 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008923
8924 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8925 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8926 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8927 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8928 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8929 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8930
8931 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8932 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8933 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8934
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008935 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008936
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008937
8938timeout server-fin <timeout>
8939 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8941 yes | no | yes | yes
8942 Arguments :
8943 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8944 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8945 as explained at the top of this document.
8946
8947 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8948 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8949 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8950 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8951 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8952 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8953 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8954 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8955 situations, it should not be needed.
8956
8957 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8958 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8959 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8960
8961 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8962
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008963
8964timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008965 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8967 yes | yes | yes | yes
8968 Arguments :
8969 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8970 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8971 as explained at the top of this document.
8972
8973 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8974 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8975 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8976
8977 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8978 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8979 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8980 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008981 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008982
8983 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8984
8985
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008986timeout tunnel <timeout>
8987 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8989 yes | no | yes | yes
8990 Arguments :
8991 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8992 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8993 as explained at the top of this document.
8994
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008995 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008996 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8997 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8998 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8999 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9000 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9001 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9002 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9003 specified.
9004
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009005 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9006 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9007 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9008 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9009 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9010 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9011 state.
9012
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009013 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9014 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9015 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9016 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9017 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9018
9019 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9020 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9021 forget about it.
9022
9023 Example :
9024 defaults http
9025 option http-server-close
9026 timeout connect 5s
9027 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009028 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009029 timeout server 30s
9030 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9031
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009032 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009033
9034
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009035transparent (deprecated)
9036 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009038 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009039 Arguments : none
9040
9041 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9042 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9043 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9044 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9045 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9046 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9047 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9048 appropriate server.
9049
9050 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9051
9052 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9053 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9054
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009055 See also: "option transparent"
9056
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009057unique-id-format <string>
9058 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9060 yes | yes | yes | no
9061 Arguments :
9062 <string> is a log-format string.
9063
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009064 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9065 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9066 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9067 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009068
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009069 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9070 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9071 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9072 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9073 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9074 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9075 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9076 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009077
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009078 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9079 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009080
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009081 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009082
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009083 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009084
9085 will generate:
9086
9087 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9088
9089 See also: "unique-id-header"
9090
9091unique-id-header <name>
9092 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9094 yes | yes | yes | no
9095 Arguments :
9096 <name> is the name of the header.
9097
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009098 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9099 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009100
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009101 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009102
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009103 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009104 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9105
9106 will generate:
9107
9108 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9109
9110 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009111
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009112use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009113 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9115 no | yes | yes | no
9116 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009117 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9118 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009119
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009120 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9121 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009122
9123 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9124 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9125 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009126 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9127 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9128 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9129 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009130
9131 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9132 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9133 assign the backend.
9134
9135 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9136 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9137 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9138 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9139 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9140 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9141
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009142 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009143 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009144 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9145 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9146 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9147
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009148 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9149 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9150 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9151 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9152 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9153 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9154 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9155 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9156 cannot be forced from the request.
9157
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009158 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009159 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9160 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9161
9162 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9163 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009164
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009165
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009166use-server <server> if <condition>
9167use-server <server> unless <condition>
9168 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9170 no | no | yes | yes
9171 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009172 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009173
9174 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9175
9176 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9177 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9178 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9179
9180 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9181 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9182 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9183 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9184 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9185 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9186 matches will assign the server.
9187
9188 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9189 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9190 with the next rules until one matches.
9191
9192 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9193 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9194 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9195 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9196
9197 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9198 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9199 stripped.
9200
9201 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9202 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9203 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9204 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9205
9206 Example :
9207 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9208 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9209 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9210 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9211 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9212 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9213 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9214 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9215 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9216
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009217 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009218
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009219
92205. Bind and Server options
9221--------------------------
9222
9223The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9224depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9225settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9226written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9227described in this section.
9228
9229
92305.1. Bind options
9231-----------------
9232
9233The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9234as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9235no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9236parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9237while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9238provided immediately after the setting name.
9239
9240The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9241
9242accept-proxy
9243 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009244 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9245 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009246 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9247 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9248 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9249 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9250 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9251 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9252 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009253 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9254 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009255
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009256alpn <protocols>
9257 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9258 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9259 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9260 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9261 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9262 initial NPN extension.
9263
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009264backlog <backlog>
9265 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9266 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9267
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009268ecdhe <named curve>
9269 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009270 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9271 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009272
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009273ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009274 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9275 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9276 client's certificate.
9277
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009278ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9280 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9281 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9282 error is ignored.
9283
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009284ca-sign-file <cafile>
9285 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9286 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9287 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9288 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9289 'generate-certificates' for details.
9290
9291ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9293 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9294 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9295 'generate-certificates' for details.
9296
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009297ciphers <ciphers>
9298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9299 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009300 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009301 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9302 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9303
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009304crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9306 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9307 to verify client's certificate.
9308
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009309crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9311 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9312 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9313 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9314 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9315 file.
9316
9317 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9318 are loaded.
9319
9320 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009321 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009322 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9323 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9324 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9325 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9326 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9327 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9328 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009329
9330 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9331 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9332 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9333 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009334 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9335 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009336
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009337 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009338
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009339 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9340 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009341 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009342 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9343 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9344 clients).
9345
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009346 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9347 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9348 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9349 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9350 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9351 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9352 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9353 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9354 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9355 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9356 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9357 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9358 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9359
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009360 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9361 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9362 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9363 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9364 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9365
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009366crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009367 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9368 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009369 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009370 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009371
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009372crt-list <file>
9373 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009374 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9375 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009376
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009377 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009378
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009379 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9380 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9381 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9382 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9383 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9384 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9385 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9386 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009387
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009388defer-accept
9389 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9390 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9391 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9392 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9393 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9394 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9395 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9396 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9397 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9398 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9399 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9400
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009401force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009402 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009403 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009404 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9405 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009406
9407force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009408 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009409 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9410 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009411
9412force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009413 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009414 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9415 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009416
9417force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009418 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009419 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9420 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009421
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009422generate-certificates
9423 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9424 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9425 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9426 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9427 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9428 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9429 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9430 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9431 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9432 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9433 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9434
9435 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9436 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9437 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9438 certificate is used many times.
9439
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009440gid <gid>
9441 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9442 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9443 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9444 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9445 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9446
9447group <group>
9448 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9449 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9450 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9451 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9452 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9453
9454id <id>
9455 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9456 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9457 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9458 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9459
9460interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009461 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9462 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9463 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9464 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9465 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9466 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9467 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009468
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009469level <level>
9470 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9471 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9472 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9473 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9474 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9475 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9476 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9477 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9478 counters).
9479 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9480 all counters).
9481
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009482maxconn <maxconn>
9483 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9484 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9485 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9486 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9487 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9488 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9489 eat all memory.
9490
9491mode <mode>
9492 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9493 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9494 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9495 UNIX sockets.
9496
9497mss <maxseg>
9498 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9499 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9500 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9501 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9502 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9503 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9504 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9505 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9506 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9507 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9508 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9509
9510name <name>
9511 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9512 page.
9513
9514nice <nice>
9515 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9516 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9517 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9518 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9519 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9520 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9521 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9522 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9523 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9524 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9525 one for an RDP socket.
9526
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009527no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009528 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009529 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009530 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009531 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9532 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009533 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009534
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009535no-tls-tickets
9536 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9537 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9538 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009539 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9540 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009541
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009542no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009543 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009544 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009545 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009546 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9547 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9548 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009549
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009550no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009552 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009553 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009554 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9555 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9556 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009557
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009558no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009559 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009560 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009561 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009562 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9563 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9564 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009565
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009566npn <protocols>
9567 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9568 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9569 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9570 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009571 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9572 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009573
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009574process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9575 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9576 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9577 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9578 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9579 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9580 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9581 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009582 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9583 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9584 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9585 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9586 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9587 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9588 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009589
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009590ssl
9591 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009592 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009593 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9594 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9595 to deciphered contents.
9596
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009597strict-sni
9598 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9599 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9600 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9601 See the "crt" option for more information.
9602
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009603tcp-ut <delay>
9604 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9605 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9606 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9607 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9608 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9609 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9610 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9611 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9612 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9613 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9614 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9615
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009616tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009617 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009618 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9619 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9620 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9621 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9622 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9623 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9624 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009625 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9626 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9627 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009628
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009629tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9630 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9631 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9632 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9633 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9634 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9635 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9636 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9637 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9638 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9639 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9640
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009641transparent
9642 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9643 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9644 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9645 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9646 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9647 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9648 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9649 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9650 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9651 so check for support with your vendor.
9652
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009653v4v6
9654 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9655 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9656 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9657 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009658 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009659
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009660v6only
9661 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9662 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9663 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009664 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9665 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009666
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009667uid <uid>
9668 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9669 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9670 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9671 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9672 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9673
9674user <user>
9675 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9676 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9677 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9678 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9679 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9680
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009681verify [none|optional|required]
9682 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9683 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9684 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9685 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9686 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009687 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9688 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9689 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9690 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009691
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020096925.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009693------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009695The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9696which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9697arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9698settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9699after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9700Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9701address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009703 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009704 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009706The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009707
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009708addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009709 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9710 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9711 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9712 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9713 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009715 Supported in default-server: No
9716
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009717agent-check
9718 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009719 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9720 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9721 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9722 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009723
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009724 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009725 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009726 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9727 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9728 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009729
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009730 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9731 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009732
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009733 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9734 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9735 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009736
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009737 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9738 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9739 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009740
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009741 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9742 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9743 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9744 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9745 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9746 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9747 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009748
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009749 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9750 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009751
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009752 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9753 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9754 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9755 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9756 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9757 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9758 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9759 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9760 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009761
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009762 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9763 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009764 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9765 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9766 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9767 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009768
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009769 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9770 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009771
9772 Supported in default-server: No
9773
9774agent-inter <delay>
9775 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9776 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9777
9778 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9779 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9780 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9781 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9782 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9783 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9784 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9785 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9786 of backends use the same servers.
9787
9788 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9789
9790 Supported in default-server: Yes
9791
9792agent-port <port>
9793 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9794
9795 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9796
9797 Supported in default-server: Yes
9798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009799backup
9800 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9801 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9802 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9803 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9804 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9805 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009806
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009807 Supported in default-server: No
9808
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009809ca-file <cafile>
9810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9811 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9812 server's certificate.
9813
9814 Supported in default-server: No
9815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009816check
9817 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009818 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9819 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9820 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9821 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9822 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9823 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9824 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009825 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9826 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9827 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009829 Supported in default-server: No
9830
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009831check-send-proxy
9832 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9833 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9834 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9835 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9836 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9837 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9838 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9839
9840 Supported in default-server: No
9841
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009842check-ssl
9843 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9844 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9845 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9846 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009847 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009848 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9849 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9850 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9851 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9852
9853 Supported in default-server: No
9854
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009855ciphers <ciphers>
9856 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009857 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009858 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9859 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9860 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9861 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9862 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9863 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9864
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009865 Supported in default-server: No
9866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009867cookie <value>
9868 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9869 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9870 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9871 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9872 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9873 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9874 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9875
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009876 Supported in default-server: No
9877
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009878crl-file <crlfile>
9879 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9880 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9881 to verify server's certificate.
9882
9883 Supported in default-server: No
9884
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009885crt <cert>
9886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9887 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9888 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9889 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9890 certificate request.
9891
9892 Supported in default-server: No
9893
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009894disabled
9895 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9896 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9897 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9898 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9899 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9900
9901 Supported in default-server: No
9902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009903error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009904 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9905 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9906 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009908 Supported in default-server: Yes
9909
9910 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009912fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009913 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9914 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9915 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9916
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009917 Supported in default-server: Yes
9918
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009919force-sslv3
9920 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9921 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009922 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9923 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009924
9925 Supported in default-server: No
9926
9927force-tlsv10
9928 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009929 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9930 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009931
9932 Supported in default-server: No
9933
9934force-tlsv11
9935 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009936 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9937 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009938
9939 Supported in default-server: No
9940
9941force-tlsv12
9942 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009943 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9944 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009945
9946 Supported in default-server: No
9947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009948id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009949 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9950 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9951 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009953 Supported in default-server: No
9954
9955inter <delay>
9956fastinter <delay>
9957downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009958 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9959 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9960 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9961 between checks depending on the server state :
9962
9963 Server state | Interval used
9964 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9965 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9966 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9967 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9968 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9969 or yet unchecked. |
9970 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9971 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9972 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009974 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9975 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9976 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9977 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009978 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9979 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9980 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9981 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9982 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009984 Supported in default-server: Yes
9985
9986maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009987 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9988 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9989 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9990 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9991 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9992 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9993 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9994 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009996 Supported in default-server: Yes
9997
9998maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009999 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10000 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10001 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10002 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10003 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10004 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10005 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10006
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010007 Supported in default-server: Yes
10008
10009minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010010 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10011 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10012 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10013 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10014 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10015 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010016 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010017 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010019 Supported in default-server: Yes
10020
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010021no-ssl-reuse
10022 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10023 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10024 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10025 and for paranoid users.
10026
10027 Supported in default-server: No
10028
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010029no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010030 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10031 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010032 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010033
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010034 Supported in default-server: No
10035
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010036no-tls-tickets
10037 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10038 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10039 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010040 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10041 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010042
10043 Supported in default-server: No
10044
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010045no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010046 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010047 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10048 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010049 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10050 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10051 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010052
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010053 Supported in default-server: No
10054
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010055no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010056 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010057 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10058 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010059 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10060 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10061 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010062
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010063 Supported in default-server: No
10064
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010065no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010066 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010067 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10068 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010069 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10070 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10071 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010072
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010073 Supported in default-server: No
10074
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010075non-stick
10076 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10077 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10078 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10079
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010080 Supported in default-server: No
10081
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010082observe <mode>
10083 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10084 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10085 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10086 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10087 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10088 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010089 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010090
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010091 Supported in default-server: No
10092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010093 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010095on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010096 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10097 Currently, four modes are available:
10098 - fastinter: force fastinter
10099 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10100 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10101 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10102 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10103
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010104 Supported in default-server: Yes
10105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010106 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10107
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010108on-marked-down <action>
10109 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10110 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010111 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10112 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10113 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10114 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10115 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10116 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10117 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10118 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010119
10120 Actions are disabled by default
10121
10122 Supported in default-server: Yes
10123
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010124on-marked-up <action>
10125 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10126 Currently one action is available:
10127 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10128 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10129 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10130 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10131 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10132 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10133 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10134 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10135
10136 Actions are disabled by default
10137
10138 Supported in default-server: Yes
10139
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010140port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010141 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10142 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10143 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10144 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10145 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10146 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10147
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010148 Supported in default-server: Yes
10149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010150redir <prefix>
10151 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10152 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10153 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10154 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10155 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10156 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10157 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10158 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010159 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010160 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10161 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10162 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10163 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10164 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10165
10166 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010168 Supported in default-server: No
10169
10170rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010171 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10172 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10173 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010175 Supported in default-server: Yes
10176
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010177resolve-prefer <family>
10178 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10179 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10180 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10181 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10182
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010183 Default value: ipv6
10184
10185 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010186
10187 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10188
10189resolvers <id>
10190 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10191 hostname.
10192
10193 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns
10194
10195 See also chapter 5.3
10196
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010197send-proxy
10198 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10199 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10200 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10201 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
10202 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
10203 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
10204 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
10205 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
10206 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010207 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
10208 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
10209 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
10210 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
10211 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010212
10213 Supported in default-server: No
10214
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010215send-proxy-v2
10216 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10217 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10218 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10219 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10220 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10221 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10222 option of the "bind" keyword.
10223
10224 Supported in default-server: No
10225
10226send-proxy-v2-ssl
10227 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10228 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10229 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10230 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10231 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10232 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10233 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10234 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10235
10236 Supported in default-server: No
10237
10238send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10239 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10240 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10241 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10242 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10243 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10244 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10245 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10246 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10247 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10248
10249 Supported in default-server: No
10250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010251slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010252 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10253 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10254 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10255 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10256 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10257 parameters :
10258
10259 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10260 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10261
10262 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10263 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10264 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10265 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10266
10267 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10268 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10269 seen as failed.
10270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010271 Supported in default-server: Yes
10272
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010273sni <expression>
10274 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10275 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10276 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10277 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10278 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10279
10280 Supported in default-server: no
10281
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010282source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010283source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010284source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010285 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10286 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10287 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10288 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10289
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010290 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10291 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10292 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10293 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10294 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10295 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10296 server.
10297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010298 Supported in default-server: No
10299
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010300ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010301 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10302 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10303 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10304 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10305 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10306 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010307 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010308
10309 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010311track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010312 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10313 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10314 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10315 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010316 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010318 Supported in default-server: No
10319
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010320verify [none|required]
10321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010322 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10323 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10324 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10325 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010326 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10327 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10328 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010329
10330 Supported in default-server: No
10331
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010332verifyhost <hostname>
10333 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10334 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10335 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10336 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10337 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10338 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10339
10340 Supported in default-server: No
10341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010342weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010343 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10344 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10345 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010346 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10347 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10348 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10349 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10350 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10351 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010352
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010353 Supported in default-server: Yes
10354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010355
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200103565.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
10357-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010358
10359HAProxy allows using a host name to be resolved to find out what is the server
10360IP address. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10361configuration, at startup.
10362This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10363can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10364workload.
10365This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10366resolution at run time.
10367Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10368carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10369
10370
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200103715.3.1. Global overview
10372----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010373
10374As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10375different steps of the process life:
10376
10377 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10378 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10379 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10380
10381 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10382 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10383 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10384
10385A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10386 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10387 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10388 resolution to know this new IP.
10389
10390A few things important to notice:
10391 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10392 first valid response.
10393
10394 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10395 servers return an error.
10396
10397
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200103985.3.2. The resolvers section
10399----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010400
10401This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10402HAProxy.
10403There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10404many name servers.
10405
10406resolvers <resolvers id>
10407 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
10408
10409A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
10410
10411nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
10412 DNS server description:
10413 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
10414 <ip> : IP address of the server
10415 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
10416
10417hold <status> <period>
10418 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
10419 on last resolution <status>
10420 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
10421 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
10422 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10423 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
10424
10425 Default value is 10s for "valid".
10426
10427 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
10428 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
10429 the healch check.
10430
10431resolve_retries <nb>
10432 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
10433 giving up.
10434 Default value: 3
10435
10436timeout <event> <time>
10437 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
10438 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
10439 events available are:
10440 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
10441 been received.
10442 Default value: 1s
10443 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10444 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
10445
10446Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
10447
10448 resolvers mydns
10449 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
10450 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
10451 resolve_retries 3
10452 timeout retry 1s
10453 hold valid 10s
10454
10455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104566. HTTP header manipulation
10457---------------------------
10458
10459In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10460response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10461request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10462which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010463against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010464
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010465If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10466to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10467but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10468HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10469stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10470because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10471a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10472still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010474This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10475in section 4.2 :
10476
10477 - reqadd <string>
10478 - reqallow <search>
10479 - reqiallow <search>
10480 - reqdel <search>
10481 - reqidel <search>
10482 - reqdeny <search>
10483 - reqideny <search>
10484 - reqpass <search>
10485 - reqipass <search>
10486 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10487 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10488 - reqtarpit <search>
10489 - reqitarpit <search>
10490 - rspadd <string>
10491 - rspdel <search>
10492 - rspidel <search>
10493 - rspdeny <search>
10494 - rspideny <search>
10495 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10496 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10497
10498With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10499is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
10500parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
10501prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
10502Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
10503
10504 \t for a tab
10505 \r for a carriage return (CR)
10506 \n for a new line (LF)
10507 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
10508 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10509 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10510 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10511 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10512
10513The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10514portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10515above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10516regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
105179 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10518is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10519
10520The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10521after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10522
10523Notes related to these keywords :
10524---------------------------------
10525 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10526 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10527 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10528
10529 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10530 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10531 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10532
10533 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10534 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10535 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10536 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10537 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10538
10539 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10540 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10541 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10542 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10543 useless headers before adding new ones.
10544
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010545 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010546 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10547
10548 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10549 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10550 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10551
10552 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10553 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010554 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010555
10556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200105577. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10558----------------------------------
10559
10560Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10561client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10562The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10563these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10564but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10565data called patterns.
10566
10567
105687.1. ACL basics
10569---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010570
10571The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10572content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10573from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10574simple :
10575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010576 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010577 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010578 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10579 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010581The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10582adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010583
10584In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010586 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010587
10588This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10589Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10590and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010591an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10592conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10593as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10594are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010595
10596ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10597'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10598which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10599
10600There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10601performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010603The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10604specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10605this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010606methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10607ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010608
10609Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10610 - boolean
10611 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10612 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10613 - string
10614 - data block
10615
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010616Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10617converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10618would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10619The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10620which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10621
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010622Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10623keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10624fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10625which are summarized in the table below :
10626
10627 +---------------------+-----------------+
10628 | Sample or converter | Default |
10629 | output type | matching method |
10630 +---------------------+-----------------+
10631 | boolean | bool |
10632 +---------------------+-----------------+
10633 | integer | int |
10634 +---------------------+-----------------+
10635 | ip | ip |
10636 +---------------------+-----------------+
10637 | string | str |
10638 +---------------------+-----------------+
10639 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10640 +---------------------+-----------------+
10641
10642Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10643matching method, see below.
10644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010645The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10646 - boolean
10647 - integer or integer range
10648 - IP address / network
10649 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10650 - regular expression
10651 - hex block
10652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010653The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10654
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010655 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10656 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010657 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010658 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010659 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010660 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010661 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010663The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10664read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10665if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10666lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10667will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10668beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10669a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10670lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10671exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10672
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010673The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10674parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10675ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10676a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10677check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10678
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010679The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10680socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10681file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010683Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10684loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10685
10686 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10687
10688In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10689the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10690case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10691as well.
10692
10693The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10694sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10695do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10696methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10697is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10698obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10699followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10700default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10701that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10702string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10703
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010704The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10705By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10706string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10707resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10708server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10709waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10710flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10711function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010713There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10714sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10715be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010716
10717 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10718 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010719 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10720 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10721 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10722 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010723
10724 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10725 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010726 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010727
10728 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010729 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010730
10731 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010732 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010733
10734 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10735 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10736
10737 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10738 binary or string samples.
10739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010740 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10741 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010743 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10744 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10745 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010747 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10748 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010750 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10751 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010753 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10754 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010756 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10757 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010758 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010760 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10761 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10762 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010763
10764For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10765request, it is possible to do :
10766
10767 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10768
10769In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10770buffer, one would use the following acl :
10771
10772 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10773
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010774On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10775possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10776
10777 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010779All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10780criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10781method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10782to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10783criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10784the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010786If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010787the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10788For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010790 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10791 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10792 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10793 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010794
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010795
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010796The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10797types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10798combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10799brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10800default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010802 +-------------------------------------------------+
10803 | Input sample type |
10804 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010805 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010806 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10807 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10808 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010809 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010810 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010811 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010812 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010813 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010814 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010815 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010816 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010817 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010818 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010819 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010820 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010821 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010822 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010823 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010824 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010825 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010826 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010827 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010828 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010829 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010830 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10831 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10832 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010833
10834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108357.1.1. Matching booleans
10836------------------------
10837
10838In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10839Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10840When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10841that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10842
10843Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10844return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10845"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108487.1.2. Matching integers
10849------------------------
10850
10851Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10852enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10853to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10854
10855Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10856matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10857lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010858
10859For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10860unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10861representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10862
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010863As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10864two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10865instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10866ranges and operators.
10867
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010868For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010869operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10870Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10871of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010872
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010873Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010874
10875 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10876 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10877 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10878 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10879 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10880
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010881For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010882
10883 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10884
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010885This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10886
10887 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10888
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108907.1.3. Matching strings
10891-----------------------
10892
10893String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10894different forms :
10895
10896 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10897 patterns ;
10898
10899 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10900 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10901
10902 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10903 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10904
10905 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10906 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10907
10908 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10909 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10910 matches.
10911
10912 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10913 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10914 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010915
10916String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10917exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10918characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10919string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10920to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010921before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010922
10923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200109247.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10925---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010926
10927Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10928they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10929possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10930passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10931the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010932the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10933match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010934
10935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200109367.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10937-------------------------------------
10938
10939It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10940not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10941a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10942to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10943digits may be used upper or lower case.
10944
10945Example :
10946 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10947 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10948
10949
109507.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10951---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010952
10953IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10954netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10955within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010956host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010957difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10958at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10959does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10960parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010961
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010962IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10963Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10964trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10965IPv6 patterns.
10966
10967HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10968following situations :
10969 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10970 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10971 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10972 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10973 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10974 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10975 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10976 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10977 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10978 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010980
109817.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10982----------------------------------
10983
10984Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10985combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10986
10987 - AND (implicit)
10988 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10989 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010991A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010993 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010995Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10996indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010998For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10999"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11000requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11001is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11002
11003 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11004 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11005 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11006 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11007
11008To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11009and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11010
11011 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11012 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11013 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11014 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11015
11016 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11017 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11018 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11019 use_backend www if host_www
11020
11021It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11022expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11023be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11024the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11025
11026 The following rule :
11027
11028 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11029 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11030
11031 Can also be written that way :
11032
11033 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11034
11035It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11036to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11037simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11038sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11039good use is the following :
11040
11041 With named ACLs :
11042
11043 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11044 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11045 monitor fail if site_dead
11046
11047 With anonymous ACLs :
11048
11049 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11050
11051See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11052
11053
110547.3. Fetching samples
11055---------------------
11056
11057Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11058against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11059sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11060ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11061of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11062available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11063
11064This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11065Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11066compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11067deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11068
11069The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11070matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11071method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11072indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11073
11074As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11075when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11076mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11077the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11078ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11079
11080Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11081multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11082when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11083incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11084are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11085is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11086all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11087
11088Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11089 - name
11090 - name(arg1)
11091 - name(arg1,arg2)
11092
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011093
110947.3.1. Converters
11095-----------------
11096
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011097Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11098of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11099is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11100was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11101has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11102unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11103
11104These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11105sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11106the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11107support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011108
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011109A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11110support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11111supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11112(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11113bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011115The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011116
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011117add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011118 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011119 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
11120 name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope. The
11121 allowed scopes are:
11122 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11123 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11124 response),
11125 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11126 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11127 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11128 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011129
11130and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011131 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011132 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11133 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11134 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11135 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11136 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11137 response),
11138 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11139 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11140 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11141 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011142
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011143base64
11144 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11145 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11146 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11147
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011148bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011149 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011150 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11151 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11152 presence of a flag).
11153
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011154bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11155 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11156 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11157 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11158
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011159cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011160 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11161 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011162
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011163crc32([<avalanche>])
11164 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11165 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11166 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11167 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11168 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11169 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11170 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11171 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11172 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11173 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11174 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11175
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011176da-csv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
11177 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11178 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11179 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11180 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
11181 ('|'). There's a limit of 5 different properties imposed by the haproxy
11182 configuration language.
11183
11184 Example:
11185 frontend www
11186 bind *:8881
11187 default_backend servers
11188 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion)]
11189
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011190debug
11191 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11192 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11193 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11194
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011195div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011196 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11197 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011198 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
11199 variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about it
11200 scope. The scope allowed are:
11201 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11202 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11203 response),
11204 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11205 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11206 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11207 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011208
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011209djb2([<avalanche>])
11210 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11211 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11212 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11213 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11214 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11215 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11216 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011217 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11218 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011219
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011220even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011221 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011222 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11223
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011224field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11225 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11226 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11227 list of chars.
11228
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011229hex
11230 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11231 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11232 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11233 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011234
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011235http_date([<offset>])
11236 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11237 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11238 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11239 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11240 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11241 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011242
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011243in_table(<table>)
11244 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11245 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11246 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11247 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11248 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11249
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011250ipmask(<mask>)
11251 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11252 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11253 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11254 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11255
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011256json([<input-code>])
11257 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11258 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11259 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11260 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11261 of errors:
11262 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11263 bytes, ...)
11264 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11265 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11266
11267 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11268 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11269 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11270 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11271 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11272 are :
11273 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11274 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11275 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11276 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11277 error ;
11278 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11279 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11280
11281 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11282 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11283
11284 Example:
11285 capture request header user-agent len 150
11286 capture request header Host len 15
11287 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
11288
11289 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11290 GET / HTTP/1.0
11291 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11292
11293 Output log:
11294 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11295
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011296language(<value>[,<default>])
11297 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11298 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11299 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11300 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11301 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11302 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11303 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11304 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11305 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11306 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11307 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11308 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011309
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011310 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011311
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011312 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11313 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011314
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011315 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11316 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11317 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11318 use_backend spanish if es
11319 use_backend french if fr
11320 use_backend english if en
11321 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011322
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011323lower
11324 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11325 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11326 type. The result is of type string.
11327
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011328ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11329 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11330 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11331 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11332 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11333 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11334 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11335
11336 Example :
11337
11338 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11339 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11340 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11341
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011342map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11343map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11344map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11345 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11346 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11347 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11348 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11349 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11350 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11351 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11352 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011353
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011354 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11355 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11356 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011357
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011358 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11359 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011360
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011361 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11362 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11363 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11364 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011365 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11366 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011367 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11368 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11369 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11370 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11371 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11372 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11373 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11374 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11375 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11376 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11377 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11378 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11379 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11380 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011381
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011382 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
11383 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
11384 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
11385 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
11386 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011387
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011388 Example :
11389
11390 # this is a comment and is ignored
11391 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
11392 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
11393 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
11394 | | | `---------- value
11395 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11396 | `---------------------------- key
11397 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11398
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011399mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011400 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11401 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011402 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11403 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11404 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11405 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11406 response),
11407 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11408 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11409 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11410 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011411
11412mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011413 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020011414 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
11415 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011416 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11417 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11418 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11419 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11420 response),
11421 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11422 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11423 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11424 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011425
11426neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011427 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
11428 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
11429 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
11430 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011431
11432not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011433 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011434 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11435 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11436 absence of a flag).
11437
11438odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011439 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011440 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
11441
11442or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011443 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011444 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11445 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11446 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11447 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11448 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11449 response),
11450 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11451 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11452 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11453 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011454
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010011455regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011456 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
11457 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
11458 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
11459 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
11460 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
11461 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
11462 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
11463 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
11464 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
11465 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
11466 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
11467 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
11468 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
11469
11470 Example :
11471
11472 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
11473 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
11474 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
11475 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
11476
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011477capture-req(<id>)
11478 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
11479 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11480
11481 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11482 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11483 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11484
11485capture-res(<id>)
11486 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
11487 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11488
11489 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11490 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11491 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11492
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011493sdbm([<avalanche>])
11494 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
11495 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11496 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11497 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11498 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11499 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11500 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011501 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
11502 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011503
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011504set-var(<var name>)
11505 Sets a variable with the input content and return the content on the output as
11506 is. The variable keep the value and the associated input type. The name of the
11507 variable starts by an indication about it scope. The scope allowed are:
11508 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11509 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11510 response),
11511 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11512 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11513 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11514 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11515
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011516sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011517 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
11518 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011519 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
11520 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
11521 scope. The allowed scopes are:
11522 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11523 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11524 response),
11525 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11526 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11527 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11528 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011529
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011530table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
11531 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11532 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11533 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
11534 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11535 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11536 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
11537
11538
11539table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
11540 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11541 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11542 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
11543 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11544 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11545 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
11546
11547table_conn_cnt(<table>)
11548 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11549 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11550 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11551 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
11552 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11553
11554table_conn_cur(<table>)
11555 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11556 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11557 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11558 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11559 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
11560
11561table_conn_rate(<table>)
11562 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11563 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11564 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
11565 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11566 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
11567
11568table_gpc0(<table>)
11569 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11570 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11571 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11572 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
11573 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
11574
11575table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
11576 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11577 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11578 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
11579 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
11580 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
11581 sample fetch keyword.
11582
11583table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
11584 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11585 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11586 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11587 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11588 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11589
11590table_http_err_rate(<table>)
11591 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11592 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11593 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
11594 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
11595 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
11596 keyword.
11597
11598table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
11599 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11600 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11601 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11602 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
11603 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11604
11605table_http_req_rate(<table>)
11606 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11607 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11608 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
11609 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
11610 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
11611 keyword.
11612
11613table_kbytes_in(<table>)
11614 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11615 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11616 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
11617 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11618 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11619 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11620 keyword.
11621
11622table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11623 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11624 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11625 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11626 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11627 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11628 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
11629 keyword.
11630
11631table_server_id(<table>)
11632 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11633 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11634 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
11635 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
11636 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
11637 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
11638
11639table_sess_cnt(<table>)
11640 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11641 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11642 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11643 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
11644 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11645 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
11646 keyword.
11647
11648table_sess_rate(<table>)
11649 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11650 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11651 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
11652 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
11653 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11654 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
11655 keyword.
11656
11657table_trackers(<table>)
11658 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11659 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11660 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11661 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
11662 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
11663 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
11664 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
11665 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
11666 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
11667 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
11668
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011669upper
11670 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
11671 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11672 type. The result is of type string.
11673
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020011674url_dec
11675 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
11676 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
11677
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011678utime(<format>[,<offset>])
11679 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11680 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
11681 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11682 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11683 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11684 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
11685
11686 Example :
11687
11688 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
11689 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11690 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11691
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010011692word(<index>,<delimiters>)
11693 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
11694 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
11695
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011696wt6([<avalanche>])
11697 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
11698 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11699 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11700 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11701 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11702 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11703 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011704 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
11705 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011706
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011707xor(<value>)
11708 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011709 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011710 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11711 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11712 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11713 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11714 response),
11715 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11716 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11717 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11718 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011719
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011720
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200117217.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011722--------------------------------------------
11723
11724A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
11725not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
11726"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
11727The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
11728
11729always_false : boolean
11730 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11731 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11732
11733always_true : boolean
11734 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11735 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11736
11737avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011738 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011739 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
11740 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
11741 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
11742 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
11743 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
11744 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
11745 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
11746 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11747 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11748 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11749 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11750 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11751 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011753be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011754 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11755 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11756 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11757 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11758 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011760be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11761 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11762 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11763 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11764 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11765 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11766 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011767
11768 Example :
11769 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11770 backend dynamic
11771 mode http
11772 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11773 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011774
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011775bin(<hexa>) : bin
11776 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
11777 of the string.
11778
11779bool(<bool>) : bool
11780 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
11781 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
11782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011783connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11784 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011785 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011786 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11787 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011788
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011789 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011790 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011791 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11792
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011793 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11794 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011795
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011796 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011797 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011798 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011799 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11800 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011801 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011802 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011803
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011804 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11805 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011806 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011807 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011808
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011809date([<offset>]) : integer
11810 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11811 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11812 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11813 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011814 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11815
11816 Example :
11817
11818 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11819 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011820
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011821env(<name>) : string
11822 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11823 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11824 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11825 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11826 certain way.
11827
11828 Examples :
11829 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11830 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11831
11832 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11833 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011835fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11836 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011837 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11838 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011839 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11840 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11841 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11842 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11843 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011845fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11846 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11847 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11848 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11849 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11850 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11851 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11852 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11853 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011854
11855 Example :
11856 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11857 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11858 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11859 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11860 frontend mail
11861 bind :25
11862 mode tcp
11863 maxconn 100
11864 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11865 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11866 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11867 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011868
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011869int(<integer>) : signed integer
11870 Returns a signed integer.
11871
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011872ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
11873 Returns an ipv4.
11874
11875ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
11876 Returns an ipv6.
11877
11878meth(<method>) : method
11879 Returns a method.
11880
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011881nbproc : integer
11882 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11883 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11884 and debugging purposes.
11885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011886nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11887 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11888 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11889 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011890 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11891 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11892 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011893
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011894proc : integer
11895 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11896 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11897 debugging purposes.
11898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011899queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011900 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11901 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11902 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011903 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11904 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11905 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11906 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11907 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11908
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011909rand([<range>]) : integer
11910 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11911 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11912 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11913 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11914 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011916srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11917 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11918 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11919 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11920 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11921 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11922 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11923 methods.
11924
11925srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11926 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11927 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11928 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11929 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11930 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11931 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11932 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11933
11934srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11935 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11936 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011937 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011938 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11939 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11940 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11941 overloading servers).
11942
11943 Example :
11944 # Redirect to a separate back
11945 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11946 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11947 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11948
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011949stopping : boolean
11950 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11951 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11952 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11953
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011954str(<string>) : string
11955 Returns a string.
11956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011957table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11958 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11959 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11960
11961table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11962 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11963 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11964 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11965
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011966var(<var-name>) : undefined
11967 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
11968 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
11969 scope. The scope allowed are:
11970 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11971 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11972 response),
11973 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11974 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11975 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11976 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011978
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200119797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011980----------------------------------
11981
11982The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11983closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11984methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11985sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11986TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011987the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11988counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11989"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011990argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11991the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11992this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011993
11994be_id : integer
11995 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11996 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11997
11998dst : ip
11999 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12000 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12001 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12002 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12003 RFC 4291.
12004
12005dst_conn : integer
12006 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12007 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12008 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12009 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12010 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12011 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12012 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12013 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012015dst_port : integer
12016 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12017 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12018 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12019 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12020 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12021 an HTTP header.
12022
12023fe_id : integer
12024 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12025 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12026 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12027
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012028sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012029sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12030sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12031sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012032 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12033 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12034 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12035
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012036sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012037sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12038sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12039sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012040 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12041 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12042 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12043
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012044sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012045sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12046sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12047sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012048 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12049 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012050 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12051 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12052 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012053
12054 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12055 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012056 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12057 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12058 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012059 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12060 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12061
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012062sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012063sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12064sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12065sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012066 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12067 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12068
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012069sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012070sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12071sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12072sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012073 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12074 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12075 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12076
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012077sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012078sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12079sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12080sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012081 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12082 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12083 See also src_conn_rate.
12084
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012085sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012086sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12087sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12088sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012089 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012090 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012091
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012092sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012093sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12094sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12095sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012096 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12097 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12098 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012099 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12100 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12101 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012102
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012103sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012104sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12105sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12106sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012107 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12108 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12109 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12110
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012111sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012112sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12113sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12114sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012115 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12116 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12117 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12118 src_http_err_rate.
12119
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012120sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012121sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12122sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12123sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012124 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12125 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12126 src_http_req_cnt.
12127
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012128sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012129sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12130sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12131sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012132 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12133 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12134 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12135 src_http_req_rate.
12136
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012137sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012138sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12139sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12140sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012141 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012142 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12143 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12144 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12145 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012146
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012147 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12148 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012149 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12150
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012151sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012152sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12153sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12154sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012155 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12156 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12157 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012158
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012159sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012160sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12161sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12162sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012163 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12164 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12165 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012166
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012167sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012168sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12169sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12170sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012171 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12172 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12173 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12174 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012175 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012176 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12177
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012178sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012179sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12180sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12181sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012182 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12183 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12184 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12185 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12186 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012187 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012188
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012189sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012190sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12191sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12192sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012193 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12194 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12195 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12196
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012197sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012198sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12199sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12200sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012201 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12202 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012203 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012204 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12205 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012206 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12207 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12208 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012210so_id : integer
12211 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12212 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12213 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012215src : ip
12216 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12217 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12218 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12219 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
12220 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
12221 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
12222 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012223
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012224 Example:
12225 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12226 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012228src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12229 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12230 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12231 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012232 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012234src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12235 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12236 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012237 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012238 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012240src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12241 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12242 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12243 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12244 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12245 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12246 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012247
12248 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12249 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12250 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12251 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012252 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012253 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12254 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012256src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012257 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012258 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012259 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012260 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012262src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012263 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012264 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12265 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012266 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012268src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12269 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12270 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12271 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012272 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012274src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012275 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012276 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012277 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012278 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012280src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012281 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012282 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012283 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
12284 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012285 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12286 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12287 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012289src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12290 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
12291 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012292 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012293 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012294 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012296src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12297 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
12298 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12299 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12300 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012301 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012303src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12304 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12305 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12306 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012307 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012309src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12310 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12311 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12312 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012313 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012314 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012316src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12317 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12318 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12319 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012320 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012321 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
12322 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012323
12324 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012325 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012326 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012328src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012329 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
12330 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
12331 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
12332 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
12333 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012335src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012336 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
12337 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12338 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
12339 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
12340 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012342src_port : integer
12343 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
12344 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
12345 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
12346 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012348src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12349 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012350 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12351 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
12352 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012353 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012355src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12356 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
12357 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12358 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12359 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012360 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012362src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12363 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
12364 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
12365 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
12366 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
12367 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
12368 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
12369 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
12370 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012371
12372 Example :
12373 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
12374 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
12375 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
12376 listen ssh
12377 bind :22
12378 mode tcp
12379 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012380 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012381 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012382 server local 127.0.0.1:22
12383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012384srv_id : integer
12385 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
12386 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
12387 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020012388
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010012389
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200123907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012391----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020012392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012393The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
12394closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
12395when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
12396usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012397future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012398
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012399ssl_bc : boolean
12400 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12401 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
12402 other a server with the "ssl" option.
12403
12404ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
12405 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
12406 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12407
12408ssl_bc_cipher : string
12409 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
12410 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12411
12412ssl_bc_protocol : string
12413 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
12414 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12415
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012416ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012417 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012418 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12419 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012420
12421ssl_bc_session_id : binary
12422 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
12423 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
12424 if session was reused or not.
12425
12426ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
12427 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
12428 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012430ssl_c_ca_err : integer
12431 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12432 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
12433 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
12434 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
12435 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012437ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
12438 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12439 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
12440 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
12441 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012442
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012443ssl_c_der : binary
12444 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
12445 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12446 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012448ssl_c_err : integer
12449 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12450 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
12451 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
12452 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
12453 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012455ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12456 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12457 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12458 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12459 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12460 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12461 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12462 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12463 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012465ssl_c_key_alg : string
12466 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12467 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12468 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012470ssl_c_notafter : string
12471 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
12472 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12473 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012475ssl_c_notbefore : string
12476 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
12477 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12478 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012480ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12481 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12482 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12483 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12484 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12485 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12486 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12487 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12488 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012490ssl_c_serial : binary
12491 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
12492 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12493 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012495ssl_c_sha1 : binary
12496 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
12497 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
12498 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020012499 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
12500 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
12501
12502 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012504ssl_c_sig_alg : string
12505 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12506 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12507 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012509ssl_c_used : boolean
12510 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
12511 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012513ssl_c_verify : integer
12514 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
12515 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
12516 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
12517 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012519ssl_c_version : integer
12520 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
12521 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012522
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012523ssl_f_der : binary
12524 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
12525 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12526 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012528ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12529 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12530 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12531 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12532 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012533 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012534 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12535 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12536 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012538ssl_f_key_alg : string
12539 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12540 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
12541 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012543ssl_f_notafter : string
12544 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12545 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12546 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012548ssl_f_notbefore : string
12549 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12550 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12551 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012553ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12554 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12555 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12556 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12557 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12558 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12559 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12560 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12561 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012563ssl_f_serial : binary
12564 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12565 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12566 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012567
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020012568ssl_f_sha1 : binary
12569 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
12570 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
12571 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
12572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012573ssl_f_sig_alg : string
12574 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12575 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12576 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012578ssl_f_version : integer
12579 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12580 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12581
12582ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012583 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12584 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
12585 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
12586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012587 Example :
12588 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
12589 listen http-https
12590 bind :80
12591 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
12592 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
12593
12594ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
12595 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
12596 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12597
12598ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012599 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012600 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
12601 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
12602 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
12603 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
12604 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
12605 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
12606 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
12607 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
12608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012609ssl_fc_cipher : string
12610 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
12611 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012613ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012614 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
12615 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010012616 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
12617 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
12618 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
12619 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012621ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
12622 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020012623 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
12624 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
12625 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12626 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012627
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020012628ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
12629 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
12630 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
12631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012632ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012633 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012634 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
12635 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
12636 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12637 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
12638 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
12639 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
12640 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020012641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012642ssl_fc_protocol : string
12643 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
12644 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012645
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012646ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012647 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012648 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12649 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012651ssl_fc_session_id : binary
12652 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
12653 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
12654 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
12655 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012657ssl_fc_sni : string
12658 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
12659 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
12660 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
12661 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
12662 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
12663
12664 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
12665 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
12666 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020012667 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12668 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012670 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012671 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
12672 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020012673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012674ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
12675 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
12676 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012677
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012678
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200126797.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012680------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012682Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
12683sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
12684only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
12685For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
12686be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
12687can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
12688sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
12689for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
12690content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012692payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
12693 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
12694 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
12695 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012697payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
12698 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
12699 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
12700 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012702req.len : integer
12703req_len : integer (deprecated)
12704 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12705 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12706 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12707 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12708 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12709 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12710 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
12711 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012713req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12714 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012715 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12716 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12717 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12718 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012720 ACL alternatives :
12721 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012723req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12724 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12725 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12726 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
12727 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012729 ACL alternatives :
12730 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012732 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012734req.proto_http : boolean
12735req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
12736 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
12737 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
12738 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
12739 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
12740 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
12741 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
12742 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012744 Example:
12745 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12746 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12747 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012748 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012750req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
12751rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12752 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
12753 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
12754 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
12755 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
12756 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
12757 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
12758 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012760 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
12761 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
12762 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
12763 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
12764 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
12765 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012767 ACL derivatives :
12768 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012770 Example :
12771 listen tse-farm
12772 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
12773 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
12774 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12775 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
12776 # apply RDP cookie persistence
12777 persist rdp-cookie
12778 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
12779 # This is only useful makes sense if
12780 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
12781 stick-table type string size 204800
12782 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
12783 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
12784 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012786 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12787 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012789req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12790rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12791 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12792 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12793 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12794 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012796 ACL derivatives :
12797 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012798
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020012799req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
12800 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
12801 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
12802 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC certificate
12803 and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that this only
12804 applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to contents
12805 deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines
12806 having the "ssl" option.
12807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012808req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12809req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12810 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12811 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12812 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12813 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12814 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12815 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12816 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012818req.ssl_sni : string
12819req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12820 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12821 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12822 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12823 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12824 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12825 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12826 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12827 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12828 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12829 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12830 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12831 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012833 ACL derivatives :
12834 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012836 Examples :
12837 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12838 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12839 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12840 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12841 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012843res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12844rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12845 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12846 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12847 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12848 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12849 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12850 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12851 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012853req.ssl_ver : integer
12854req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12855 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12856 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12857 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12858 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12859 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12860 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12861 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12862 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12863 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012865 ACL derivatives :
12866 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012867
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012868res.len : integer
12869 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12870 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12871 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12872 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12873 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12874 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12875 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12876 content inspection.
12877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012878res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12879 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012880 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12881 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12882 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12883 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012885res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12886 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12887 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12888 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12889 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012891 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012893wait_end : boolean
12894 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12895 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12896 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12897 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12898 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12899 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12900 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12901 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012903 Examples :
12904 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12905 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12906 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012908 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12909 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12910 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12911 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12912 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12913 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12914 tcp-request content reject
12915
12916
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200129177.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012918--------------------------------------
12919
12920It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12921This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12922data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12923its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12924HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12925content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12926to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12927more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12928response are indexed.
12929
12930base : string
12931 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12932 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12933 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12934 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12935 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12936 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12937 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12938 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12939
12940 ACL derivatives :
12941 base : exact string match
12942 base_beg : prefix match
12943 base_dir : subdir match
12944 base_dom : domain match
12945 base_end : suffix match
12946 base_len : length match
12947 base_reg : regex match
12948 base_sub : substring match
12949
12950base32 : integer
12951 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12952 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12953 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012954 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12955 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12956 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012957
12958base32+src : binary
12959 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12960 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12961 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12962 per-URL counters.
12963
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012964capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12965 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12966 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12967 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12968
12969capture.req.method : string
12970 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12971 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12972 because it's allocated.
12973
12974capture.req.uri : string
12975 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12976 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12977 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12978 allocated.
12979
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012980capture.req.ver : string
12981 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12982 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12983 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12984
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012985capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12986 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12987 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12988 The first entry is an index of 0.
12989 See also: "capture response header"
12990
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012991capture.res.ver : string
12992 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12993 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12994 persistent flag.
12995
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012996req.body : binary
12997 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
12998 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12999 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13000 the first chunk is analyzed.
13001
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013002req.body_param([<name>) : string
13003 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13004 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13005 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13006 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13007 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13008 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13009 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13010 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13011 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13012 given.
13013
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013014req.body_len : integer
13015 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13016 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13017 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13018 "option http-buffer-request".
13019
13020req.body_size : integer
13021 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13022 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13023 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13024 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13025 "option http-buffer-request".
13026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013027req.cook([<name>]) : string
13028cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13029 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13030 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13031 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13032 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13033 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13034 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13035 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13036 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13037
13038 ACL derivatives :
13039 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13040 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13041 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13042 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13043 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13044 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13045 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13046 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013048req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13049cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13050 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13051 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013053req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13054cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13055 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13056 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13057 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13058 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013060cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13061 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13062 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13063 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13064 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
13065 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
13066 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13067 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13068 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13069 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
13070 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013072hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13073 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13074 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13075 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13076 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013077 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013079req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13080 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13081 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13082 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13083 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13084 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13085 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13086 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13087 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013089req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13090 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13091 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13092 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13093 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013095req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13096 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13097 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13098 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13099 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13100 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13101 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13102 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13103 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13104 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13105 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13106 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013108 ACL derivatives :
13109 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13110 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13111 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13112 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13113 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13114 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13115 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13116 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13117
13118req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13119hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13120 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13121 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13122 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13123 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13124 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13125 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13126 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13127 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13128 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13129
13130req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13131hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13132 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13133 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13134 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13135 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13136 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13137 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13138 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13139 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13140
13141req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13142hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13143 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13144 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13145 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13146 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13147 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13148 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13149 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13150
13151http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13152 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13153 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13154 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13155 basic auth is supported.
13156
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013157http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13158 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13159 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13160 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13161 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013162 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13163 basic auth is supported.
13164
13165 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013166 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13167 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13168 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13169 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013170
13171http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013172 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13173 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013174 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13175 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013177method : integer + string
13178 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
13179 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
13180 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
13181 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
13182 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
13183 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
13184 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013186 ACL derivatives :
13187 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013189 Example :
13190 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13191 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13192 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013194path : string
13195 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13196 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13197 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13198 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13199 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13200 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13201 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013203 ACL derivatives :
13204 path : exact string match
13205 path_beg : prefix match
13206 path_dir : subdir match
13207 path_dom : domain match
13208 path_end : suffix match
13209 path_len : length match
13210 path_reg : regex match
13211 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013212
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013213query : string
13214 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13215 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13216 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13217 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13218 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13219 which stops before the question mark.
13220
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013221req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13222 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13223 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13224 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13225 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013227req.ver : string
13228req_ver : string (deprecated)
13229 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13230 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13231 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013233 ACL derivatives :
13234 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013236res.comp : boolean
13237 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13238 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13239 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013241res.comp_algo : string
13242 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13243 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13244 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013246res.cook([<name>]) : string
13247scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13248 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13249 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13250 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013252 ACL derivatives :
13253 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013255res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13256scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13257 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13258 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13259 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013261res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13262scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13263 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13264 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13265 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013267res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13268 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13269 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13270 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13271 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13272 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
13273 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
13274 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
13275 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
13276 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013278res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13279 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13280 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13281 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13282 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
13283 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013285res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13286shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
13287 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13288 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13289 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13290 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13291 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
13292 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
13293 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
13294 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013296 ACL derivatives :
13297 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13298 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13299 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13300 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13301 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13302 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13303 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13304 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13305
13306res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13307shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13308 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13309 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13310 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
13311 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
13312 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013314res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13315shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13316 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
13317 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
13318 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
13319 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
13320 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
13321 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013322
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013323res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13324 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13325 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13326 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13327 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013329res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13330shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13331 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
13332 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13333 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13334 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13335 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
13336 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013338res.ver : string
13339resp_ver : string (deprecated)
13340 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
13341 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013343 ACL derivatives :
13344 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013346set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13347 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13348 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
13349 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
13350 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013352 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
13353 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013355 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013357status : integer
13358 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
13359 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
13360 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013362url : string
13363 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
13364 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
13365 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
13366 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
13367 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
13368 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
13369 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013371 ACL derivatives :
13372 url : exact string match
13373 url_beg : prefix match
13374 url_dir : subdir match
13375 url_dom : domain match
13376 url_end : suffix match
13377 url_len : length match
13378 url_reg : regex match
13379 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013381url_ip : ip
13382 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
13383 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
13384 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
13385 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
13386 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
13387 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13388 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013390url_port : integer
13391 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
13392 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
13393 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13394 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013395
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013396urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
13397url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013398 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
13399 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013400 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
13401 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
13402 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
13403 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013404 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
13405 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013406 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
13407 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013409 ACL derivatives :
13410 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
13411 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
13412 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
13413 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
13414 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
13415 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
13416 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
13417 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013418
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013420 Example :
13421 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
13422 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
13423 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
13424 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013425
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013426urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013427 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
13428 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
13429 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020013430
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010013431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134327.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013433---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013435Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
13436every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013437order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013439ACL name Equivalent to Usage
13440---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013441FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020013442HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013443HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
13444HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013445HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
13446HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
13447HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
13448HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
13449LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013450METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
13451METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
13452METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
13453METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
13454METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
13455METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013456RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013457REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013458TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013459WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
13460---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013461
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010013462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134638. Logging
13464----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013465
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013466One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
13467provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
13468very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
13469provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
13470state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013471to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013472headers.
13473
13474In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
13475about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
13476send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
13477
13478 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
13479 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
13480 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
13481 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
13482 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060013483 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
13484 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013485
13486The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
13487allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
13488as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
13489while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
13490real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
13491delay.
13492
13493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134948.1. Log levels
13495---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013496
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013497TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013498source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013499HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
13500in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
13501track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
13502syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
13503about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013504
13505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135068.2. Log formats
13507----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013508
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013509HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013510and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
13511slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
13512options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013513
13514 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
13515 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
13516 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
13517 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
13518 extents.
13519
13520 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
13521 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
13522 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
13523 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
13524 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
13525
13526 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
13527 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
13528 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
13529 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
13530 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
13531
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020013532 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
13533 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
13534 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
13535 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
13536
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013537 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
13538
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013539Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
13540specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
13541field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
13542servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
13543always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
13544identifier.
13545
13546Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
13547 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
13548 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
13549 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
13550 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
13551
13552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135538.2.1. Default log format
13554-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013555
13556This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
13557as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
13558format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
13559
13560 Example :
13561 listen www
13562 mode http
13563 log global
13564 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13565
13566 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
13567 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
13568 (www/HTTP)
13569
13570 Field Format Extract from the example above
13571 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
13572 2 'Connect from' Connect from
13573 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
13574 4 'to' to
13575 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
13576 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
13577
13578Detailed fields description :
13579 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
13580 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
13581 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
13582 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
13583 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13584 and processed the connection.
13585 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
13586
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013587In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
13588"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
13589connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
13590
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013591It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
13592will eventually disappear.
13593
13594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135958.2.2. TCP log format
13596---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013597
13598The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
13599is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
13600information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
13601counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
13602emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
13603environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
13604the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
13605sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013606specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
13607not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
13608fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
13609marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013610
13611 Example :
13612 frontend fnt
13613 mode tcp
13614 option tcplog
13615 log global
13616 default_backend bck
13617
13618 backend bck
13619 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13620
13621 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
13622 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
13623 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
13624
13625 Field Format Extract from the example above
13626 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
13627 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
13628 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
13629 4 frontend_name fnt
13630 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
13631 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
13632 7 bytes_read* 212
13633 8 termination_state --
13634 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
13635 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13636
13637Detailed fields description :
13638 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013639 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13640 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13641 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13642 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13643 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013644
13645 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013646 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13647 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13648 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013649
13650 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
13651 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
13652 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
13653 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
13654
13655 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13656 and processed the connection.
13657
13658 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13659 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13660 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
13661 applications.
13662
13663 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13664 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13665 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13666 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
13667 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
13668
13669 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13670 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13671 See "Timers" below for more details.
13672
13673 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13674 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13675 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
13676 "Timers" below for more details.
13677
13678 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013679 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013680 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13681 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13682 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13683 details.
13684
13685 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
13686 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
13687 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
13688 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
13689 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
13690
13691 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13692 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13693 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
13694 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
13695 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
13696 for more details.
13697
13698 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013699 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013700 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
13701 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
13702 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013703 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013704
13705 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13706 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13707 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13708 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13709 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13710 caused by a denial of service attack.
13711
13712 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13713 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13714 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13715 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13716 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13717 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13718 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13719 denial of service attack.
13720
13721 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13722 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13723 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13724 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13725 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13726 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13727 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13728 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
13729 be processed than on other servers.
13730
13731 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13732 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13733 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13734 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13735 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13736 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13737 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13738 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13739 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13740 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13741 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13742 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13743 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13744
13745 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13746 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13747 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13748 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13749 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13750 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13751 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13752 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13753
13754 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13755 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13756 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13757 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13758 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13759 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13760 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13761 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13762 occurs.
13763
13764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137658.2.3. HTTP log format
13766----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013767
13768The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
13769is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
13770the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
13771are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
13772emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
13773generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
13774"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
13775which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013776frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
13777is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013778
13779Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
13780slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
13781with a star ('*') after the field name below.
13782
13783 Example :
13784 frontend http-in
13785 mode http
13786 option httplog
13787 log global
13788 default_backend bck
13789
13790 backend static
13791 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13792
13793 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
13794 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
13795 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013796 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013797
13798 Field Format Extract from the example above
13799 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
13800 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
13801 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
13802 4 frontend_name http-in
13803 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
13804 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
13805 7 status_code 200
13806 8 bytes_read* 2750
13807 9 captured_request_cookie -
13808 10 captured_response_cookie -
13809 11 termination_state ----
13810 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
13811 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13812 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
13813 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
13814 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013815
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013816
13817Detailed fields description :
13818 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013819 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13820 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13821 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13822 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13823 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013824
13825 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013826 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13827 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13828 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013829
13830 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13831 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13832 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13833 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13834 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13835
13836 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13837 and processed the connection.
13838
13839 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13840 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13841 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13842
13843 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13844 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13845 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13846 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13847 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13848 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13849
13850 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13851 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13852 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13853 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13854 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13855 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13856
13857 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13858 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13859 See "Timers" below for more details.
13860
13861 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13862 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13863 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13864 below for more details.
13865
13866 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13867 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13868 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13869 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13870 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13871 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13872 for more details.
13873
13874 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013875 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013876 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13877 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13878 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13879 details.
13880
13881 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13882 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13883 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13884
13885 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13886 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13887 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13888 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13889 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13890 overflowing.
13891
13892 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13893 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13894 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13895 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13896 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13897 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13898 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13899 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13900
13901 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13902 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13903 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13904 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13905 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13906 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13907 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13908 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13909
13910 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13911 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13912 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13913 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13914 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13915 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13916 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13917
13918 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013919 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013920 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13921 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13922 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013923 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013924 system.
13925
13926 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13927 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13928 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13929 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13930 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13931 caused by a denial of service attack.
13932
13933 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13934 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13935 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13936 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13937 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13938 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13939 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13940 denial of service attack.
13941
13942 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13943 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13944 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13945 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13946 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13947 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13948 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13949 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13950 processed than on other servers.
13951
13952 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13953 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13954 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13955 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13956 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13957 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13958 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13959 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13960 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13961 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13962 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13963 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13964 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13965
13966 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13967 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13968 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13969 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13970 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13971 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13972 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13973 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13974
13975 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13976 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13977 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13978 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13979 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13980 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13981 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13982 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13983 occurs.
13984
13985 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13986 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13987 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13988 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13989 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13990 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13991 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13992 cookies" below for more details.
13993
13994 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13995 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13996 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13997 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13998 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13999 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14000 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14001 and cookies" below for more details.
14002
14003 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14004 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14005 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14006 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14007 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14008 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14009 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14010 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14011
14012
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200140138.2.4. Custom log format
14014------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014015
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014016The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014017mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014018
14019HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14020Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14021separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14022prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14023
14024Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14025variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
14026string formats ("Q").
14027
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014028If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014029as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014030less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14031the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14032
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014033Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014034In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014035in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014036
14037Flags are :
14038 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014039 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014040
14041 Example:
14042
14043 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14044 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14045
14046At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14047
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014048 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
14049 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014050
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014051the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014052
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014053 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014054 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014055 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014056
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014057and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14058
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014059 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014060 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
14061
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014062Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14063
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014064 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014065 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014066 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14067 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14068 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014069 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14070 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14071 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014072 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014073 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14074 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014075 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014076 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14077 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014078 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014079 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014080 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014081 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014082 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014083 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
14084 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014085 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014086 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14087 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014088 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014089 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14090 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014091 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14092 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14093 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014094 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014095 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14096 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014097 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014098 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14099 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14100 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014101 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014102 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014103 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14104 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14105 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14106 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014107 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014108 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014109 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014110 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014111 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014112 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014113 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14114 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14115 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014116 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014117 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14118 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014119 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014120 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014121 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014122 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014123
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014124 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014125
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014126
141278.2.5. Error log format
14128-----------------------
14129
14130When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14131protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14132By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14133"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14134will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14135logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14136
14137The format looks like this :
14138
14139 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
14140 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
14141 Connection error during SSL handshake
14142
14143 Field Format Extract from the example above
14144 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
14145 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
14146 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
14147 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
14148 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
14149
14150These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
14151failures.
14152
14153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141548.3. Advanced logging options
14155-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014156
14157Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
14158just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
14159options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
14160for more information about their usage.
14161
14162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141638.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
14164------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014165
14166It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
14167haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
14168commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
14169monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
14170ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
14171
14172 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
14173 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
14174 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
14175 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
14176
14177 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
14178 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
14179 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014180 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014181 such as other load-balancers.
14182
14183 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
14184 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
14185 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
14186
14187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141888.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
14189----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014190
14191The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14192what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14193or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14194"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14195just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14196log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14197after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14198is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14199with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14200with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14201
14202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142038.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14204------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014205
14206Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14207for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14208"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14209retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14210raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14211a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14212file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14213you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14214"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14215
14216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142178.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14218--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014219
14220Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14221multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14222them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14223"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14224logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14225error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14226and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14227too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14228useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14229alternative.
14230
14231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142328.4. Timing events
14233------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014234
14235Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14236reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14237the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14238frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
14239mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
14240
14241 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
14242 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
14243 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
14244 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
14245 the client closes prematurely or times out.
14246
14247 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
14248 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
14249 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
14250 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
14251 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
14252
14253 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
14254 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
14255 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
14256 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
14257 connection never established.
14258
14259 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
14260 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
14261 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
14262 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
14263 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
14264 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
14265 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
14266 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
14267 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
14268 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
14269 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
14270
14271 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
14272 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
14273 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
14274 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014275 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014276
14277 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
14278
14279 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
14280 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
14281 negative.
14282
14283These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
14284protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
14285that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014286due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014287close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
14288session has been aborted on timeout.
14289
14290Most common cases :
14291
14292 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14293 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
14294 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
14295 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
14296 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
14297 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
14298 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
14299 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
14300 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020014301 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
14302 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
14303 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014304
14305 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14306 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
14307 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
14308 of ms on remote networks.
14309
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014310 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
14311 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
14312 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014313
14314 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
14315 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
14316 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
14317 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
14318 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
14319 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
14320 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
14321 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
14322 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
14323 to the server until another one is released.
14324
14325Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
14326
14327 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
14328 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
14329 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
14330
14331 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
14332 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
14333 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
14334
14335 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
14336 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
14337 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
14338 flags.
14339
14340 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
14341 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
14342 Check the session termination flags, then check the
14343 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
14344 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
14345 the client connection was maintained open.
14346
14347 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014348 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014349 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
14350 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
14351
14352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143538.5. Session state at disconnection
14354-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014355
14356TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
14357"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
143582-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
14359each of which has a special meaning :
14360
14361 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
14362 session to terminate :
14363
14364 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
14365
14366 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
14367 server explicitly refused it.
14368
14369 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
14370 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
14371 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
14372 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014373 (eg: cacheable cookie).
14374
14375 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
14376 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014377
14378 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
14379 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
14380 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
14381 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
14382 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
14383
14384 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
14385 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
14386 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
14387 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
14388 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
14389
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090014390 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
14391 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
14392
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014393 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
14394 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
14395 backup connections when going up.
14396
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020014397 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
14398
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014399 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
14400 send or receive data.
14401
14402 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
14403 send or receive data.
14404
14405 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
14406 with nothing left in the buffers.
14407
14408 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
14409
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010014410 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014411 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
14412
14413 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
14414 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
14415 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
14416 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
14417 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
14418
14419 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
14420 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
14421
14422 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
14423 server (HTTP only).
14424
14425 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
14426
14427 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
14428 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
14429 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
14430
14431 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
14432 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
14433 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
14434
14435 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
14436
14437 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
14438 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
14439
14440 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
14441 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
14442 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
14443
14444 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
14445 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020014446 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
14447 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014448
14449 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
14450 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
14451 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
14452 another server.
14453
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014454 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014455 server.
14456
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014457 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
14458 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
14459 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
14460 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14461
14462 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
14463 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
14464 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
14465 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14466
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020014467 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
14468 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
14469 "use-server" rule).
14470
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014471 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14472
14473 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
14474 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
14475
14476 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
14477
14478 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
14479 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
14480 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
14481
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014482 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
14483 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014484 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014485 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
14486 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
14487
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014488 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
14489
14490 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
14491 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
14492
14493 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
14494
14495 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14496
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014497The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
14498was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014499helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
14500starvation, attacks, etc...
14501
14502The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
14503alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
14504easier finding and understanding.
14505
14506 Flags Reason
14507
14508 -- Normal termination.
14509
14510 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
14511 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
14512 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
14513 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
14514
14515 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
14516 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
14517 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
14518 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
14519 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
14520 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014521
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014522 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14523 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014524 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014525
14526 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
14527 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
14528 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
14529
14530 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
14531 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
14532 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
14533 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
14534 the server takes too long to respond.
14535
14536 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
14537 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
14538 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
14539 long a time to respond.
14540
14541 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
14542 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
14543 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
14544 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014545 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
14546 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014547
14548 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
14549 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
14550 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
14551 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
14552 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014553 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014554 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
14555 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
14556 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
14557 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
14558 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
14559 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
14560 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
14561 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
14562 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
14563 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
14564 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
14565 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014566
14567 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
14568 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014569 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
14570 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
14571 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
14572 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014573
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014574 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
14575 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
14576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014577 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014578 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
14579 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
14580 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
14581 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
14582 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
14583
14584 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
14585 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
14586 503 or 504 here.
14587
14588 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
14589 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
14590 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
14591 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
14592 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
14593
14594 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14595 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014596 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014597 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
14598 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
14599
14600 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
14601 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
14602 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
14603 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
14604 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
14605 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
14606 between haproxy and the server.
14607
14608 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
14609 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
14610 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
14611 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
14612 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
14613 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
14614 solution is to fix the application.
14615
14616 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
14617 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
14618 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
14619 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
14620 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
14621 external attacks.
14622
14623 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
14624 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014625 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014626 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
14627 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
14628
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014629 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
14630 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
14631 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020014632 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
14633 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014634
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014635 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
14636 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
14637 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
14638 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014639 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
14640 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
14641 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
14642 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
14643 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014644
14645 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
14646 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
14647 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
14648 returned an HTTP 403 error.
14649
14650 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
14651 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
14652 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
14653 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
14654
14655 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
14656 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
14657 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
14658 only be solved by proper system tuning.
14659
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014660The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
14661persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
14662important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
14663re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
14664
14665 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
14666
14667 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14668 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
14669 set on a GET request.
14670
14671 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
14672 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014673 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014674 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
14675
14676 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
14677 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
14678 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
14679
14680 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14681 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
14682 already got a cookie.
14683
14684 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14685 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
14686 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
14687 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
14688 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
14689
14690 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14691 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14692 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14693
14694 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
14695 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14696 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14697
14698 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
14699 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
14700
14701 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
14702 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
14703 then advertised in the response.
14704
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147068.6. Non-printable characters
14707-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014708
14709In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
14710consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
14711converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
14712prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
14713being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
14714escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
14715is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
14716'}' when logging headers.
14717
14718Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
14719issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
14720containing spaces is "User-Agent".
14721
14722Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
14723the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
14724performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
14725
14726
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147278.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
14728---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014729
14730Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
14731achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014732section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014733cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
14734the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
14735the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014736locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014737not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
14738user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
14739a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
14740wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
14741
14742 Examples :
14743 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
14744 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
14745
14746 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
14747 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
14748
14749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147508.8. Capturing HTTP headers
14751---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014752
14753Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
14754proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
14755the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
14756server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
14757
14758Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
14759response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014760section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014761
14762It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014763time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
14764appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014765are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
14766and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
14767follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
14768request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
14769in the logs.
14770
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014771As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
14772frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
14773an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
14774
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014775 Example :
14776 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
14777 listen proxy-out
14778 mode http
14779 option httplog
14780 option logasap
14781 log global
14782 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
14783
14784 # log the name of the virtual server
14785 capture request header Host len 20
14786
14787 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
14788 capture request header Content-Length len 10
14789
14790 # log the beginning of the referrer
14791 capture request header Referer len 20
14792
14793 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
14794 capture response header Server len 20
14795
14796 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
14797 capture response header Content-Length len 10
14798
14799 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
14800 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
14801
14802 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
14803 capture response header Via len 20
14804
14805 # log the URL location during a redirection
14806 capture response header Location len 20
14807
14808 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
14809 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
14810 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14811 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
14812 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
14813
14814 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14815 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14816 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14817 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014818 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014819
14820 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14821 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14822 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14823 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
14824 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014825 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014826
14827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148288.9. Examples of logs
14829---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014830
14831These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14832them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14833reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14834
14835 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14836 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14837 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14838
14839 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14840 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14841
14842 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14843 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14844 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14845
14846 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14847 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14848
14849 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14850 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14851 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14852
14853 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014854 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014855 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14856 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14857
14858 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14859 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14860 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14861
14862 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14863 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014864 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014865 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14866 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14867 to return the 502 and not the server.
14868
14869 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014870 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014871
14872 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14873 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14874 Nothing was sent to any server.
14875
14876 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14877 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14878
14879 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14880 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14881 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14882 send a 408 return code to the client.
14883
14884 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14885 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14886
14887 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14888 5 seconds ("c----").
14889
14890 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14891 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014892 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014893
14894 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014895 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014896 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14897 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14898 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14899 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14900 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014901
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149039. Statistics and monitoring
14904----------------------------
14905
14906It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14907mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14908CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14909Unix socket.
14910
14911
149129.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014913---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014914
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014915The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014916page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14917begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14918represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14919use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14920('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14921(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14922text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14923do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14924use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014925
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014926In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14927that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14928S (Servers).
14929
14930 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14931 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14932 any name for server/listener)
14933 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14934 number queued without a server assigned.
14935 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14936 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14937 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14938 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14939 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14940 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14941 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14942 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14943 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14944 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14945 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14946 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14947 "option checkcache".
14948 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14949 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14950 - read error from the client
14951 - client timeout
14952 - client closed connection
14953 - various bad requests from the client.
14954 - request was tarpitted.
14955 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14956 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14957 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14958 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14959 active servers).
14960 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14961 Some other errors are:
14962 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14963 - failure applying filters to the response.
14964 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14965 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14966 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14967 switched away from.
14968 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissis1f673c72015-05-02 20:30:44 +020014969 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
14970 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
14971 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014972 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14973 the server is up.)
14974 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14975 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14976 counters for each server.
14977 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14978 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14979 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14980 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14981 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14982 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14983 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14984 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14985 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14986 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14987 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14988 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14989 of times that server was selected.
14990 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14991 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14992 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14993 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14994 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14995 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014996 UNK -> unknown
14997 INI -> initializing
14998 SOCKERR -> socket error
14999 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080015000 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015001 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
15002 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
15003 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
15004 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
15005 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
15006 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
15007 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
15008 disable-on-404
15009 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
15010 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
15011 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040015012 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
15013 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
15014 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
15015 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
15016 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
15017 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
15018 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
15019 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
15020 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
15021 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
15022 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
15023 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
15024 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
15025 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
15026 (inc. in eresp)
15027 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
15028 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
15029 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
15030 (CPU/BW limit)
15031 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
15032 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
15033 server/backend
15034 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
15035 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
15036 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
15037 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
15038 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
15039 (0 for TCP)
15040 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
15041 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015042
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150449.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015045-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015046
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020015047The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
15048necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
15049A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
15050issuing commands by hand :
15051
15052 global
15053 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
15054 stats timeout 2m
15055
15056It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
15057the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
15058never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
15059situations :
15060
15061 global
15062 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
15063 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
15064 stats timeout 2m
15065
15066To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
15067swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
15068to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
15069syntaxes we'll use are the following :
15070
15071 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
15072 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
15073
15074The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
15075script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
15076for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
15077
15078The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
15079that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
15080editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
15081(eg: watch a counter).
15082
15083The socket supports two operation modes :
15084 - interactive
15085 - non-interactive
15086
15087The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
15088this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
15089sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
15090mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
15091commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
15092example :
15093
15094 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
15095
15096The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
15097entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
15098for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
15099sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
15100"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
15101after processing the last command of the same line.
15102
15103For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
15104"prompt" command :
15105
15106 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
15107 prompt
15108 > show info
15109 ...
15110 >
15111
15112Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
15113delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
15114that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
15115parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015116
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015117It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
15118on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
15119own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015120
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020015121The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
15122If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
15123all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
15124it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
15125
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015126add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015127 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
15128 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
15129 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
15130 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015131
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015132add map <map> <key> <value>
15133 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
15134 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015135 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
15136 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
15137 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015138
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015139clear counters
15140 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
15141 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
15142 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
15143 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
15144 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15145
15146clear counters all
15147 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
15148 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
15149 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
15150
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015151clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015152 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
15153 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
15154 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015155
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015156clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015157 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
15158 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
15159 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015160
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015161clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
15162 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
15163
15164 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
15165 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
15166 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
15167 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
15168 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
15169 later after the session ends is usual enough.
15170
15171 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
15172
15173 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
15174 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
15175 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
15176 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
15177 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
15178 the ACLs :
15179
15180 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15181 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15182 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15183 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15184 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15185 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15186
15187 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015188 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
15189 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015190
15191 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015192 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020015193 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015194 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15195 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15196 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15197 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015198
15199 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15200
15201 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020015202 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015203 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15204 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015205 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15206 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15207 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015208
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015209del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
15210 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015211 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
15212 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15213 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
15214 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015215
15216del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015217 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015218 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
15219 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15220 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
15221 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015222
15223disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015224 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
15225
15226 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
15227 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
15228 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
15229 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
15230 re-enabled using enable agent.
15231
15232 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
15233 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
15234 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
15235 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
15236 otherwise unchanged.
15237
15238 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
15239 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
15240 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
15241
15242 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15243 level "admin".
15244
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015245disable frontend <frontend>
15246 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
15247 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
15248 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
15249 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
15250 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
15251 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
15252 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
15253 on the stats page.
15254
15255 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15256 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15257
15258 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15259 level "admin".
15260
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015261disable health <backend>/<server>
15262 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
15263 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
15264 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
15265 agent check forces it down.
15266
15267 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15268 level "admin".
15269
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015270disable server <backend>/<server>
15271 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
15272 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
15273 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
15274 during the maintenance.
15275
15276 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
15277 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
15278
15279 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015280 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015281
15282 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15283 level "admin".
15284
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015285enable agent <backend>/<server>
15286 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
15287
15288 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
15289 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
15290
15291 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15292 level "admin".
15293
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015294enable frontend <frontend>
15295 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
15296 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
15297 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
15298 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
15299 which was disabled.
15300
15301 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15302 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15303
15304 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15305 level "admin".
15306
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015307enable health <backend>/<server>
15308 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
15309 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
15310
15311 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15312 level "admin".
15313
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015314enable server <backend>/<server>
15315 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
15316 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
15317
15318 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015319 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015320
15321 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15322 level "admin".
15323
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015324get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015325get acl <acl> <value>
15326 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
15327 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
15328 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
15329 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
15330 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015331
15332 The first two words are:
15333
15334 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
15335 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
15336 "dom", "end" or "reg".
15337
15338 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
15339
15340 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
15341
15342 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
15343
15344 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
15345 interpretation of the case.
15346
15347 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
15348 useful with regular expressions.
15349
15350 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
15351 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
15352
15353 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
15354 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
15355 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
15356
15357 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
15358
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015359get weight <backend>/<server>
15360 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
15361 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
15362 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
15363 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
15364 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015365 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015366
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015367help
15368 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
15369 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015370
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015371prompt
15372 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
15373 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
15374 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
15375 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
15376 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
15377 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
15378 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
15379 command.
15380
15381quit
15382 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015383
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015384set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015385 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
15386 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
15387 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015388
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015389set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020015390 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
15391 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
15392 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
15393 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
15394 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015395 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
15396 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15397
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020015398set maxconn global <maxconn>
15399 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
15400 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
15401 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
15402 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
15403 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
15404 setting.
15405
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020015406set rate-limit connections global <value>
15407 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
15408 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15409 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15410 is passed in number of connections per second.
15411
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015412set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
15413 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
15414 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010015415 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
15416 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015417
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020015418set rate-limit sessions global <value>
15419 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
15420 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15421 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15422 is passed in number of sessions per second.
15423
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020015424set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
15425 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
15426 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15427 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15428 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
15429 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
15430
Baptiste Assmann3d8f8312015-04-13 22:54:33 +020015431set server <backend>/<server> addr <ip4 or ip6 address>
15432 Replace the current IP address of a server by the one provided.
15433
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020015434set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
15435 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15436 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
15437 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15438
15439set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
15440 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15441 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
15442 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15443
15444set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
15445 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
15446 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
15447 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
15448 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
15449 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
15450 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
15451 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
15452 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
15453
15454set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
15455 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
15456 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
15457
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015458set ssl ocsp-response <response>
15459 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
15460 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
15461 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
15462 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
15463
15464 Example:
15465 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
15466 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
15467 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
15468 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
15469
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015470set ssl tls-key <id> <tlskey>
15471 Set the next TLS key for the <id> listener to <tlskey>. This key becomes the
15472 ultimate key, while the penultimate one is used for encryption (others just
15473 decrypt). The oldest TLS key present is overwritten. <id> is either a numeric
15474 #<id> or <file> returned by "show tls-keys". <tlskey> is a base64 encoded 48
15475 bit TLS ticket key (ex. openssl rand -base64 48).
15476
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015477set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015478 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
15479 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
15480 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
15481 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015482 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
15483 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015484
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015485set timeout cli <delay>
15486 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
15487 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
15488 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
15489
15490set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
15491 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
15492 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090015493 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
15494 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
15495 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
15496 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
15497 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
15498 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
15499 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
15500 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
15501 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
15502 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
15503 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
15504 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
15505 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015506
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015507show errors [<iid>]
15508 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
15509 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015510 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
15511 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
15512 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015513
15514 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
15515 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
15516 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
15517 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
15518 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
15519 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
15520 are reported too.
15521
15522 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
15523 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
15524 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
15525 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
15526 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
15527 code.
15528
15529 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
15530 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
15531 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
15532 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
15533 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
15534 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
15535 line.
15536
15537 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015538 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15539 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015540 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
15541 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
15542
15543 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
15544 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
15545 00038 Location: blah\r\n
15546 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
15547 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
15548 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
15549 00204+ minal\r\n
15550 00211 \r\n
15551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015552 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015553 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
15554 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
15555 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
15556 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
15557 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
15558 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015559
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015560show info
15561 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
15562
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015563show map [<map>]
15564 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015565 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
15566 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
15567 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
15568 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
15569 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
15570 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015571
15572show acl [<acl>]
15573 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015574 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
15575 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
15576 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
15577 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
15578 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015579
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010015580show pools
15581 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
15582 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
15583 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
15584 the pools.
15585
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015586show sess
15587 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015588 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
15589 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15590
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010015591show sess <id>
15592 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
15593 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15594 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
15595 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
15596 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020015597 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
15598 returned in src/dumpstats.c
15599
15600 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
15601 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015602
15603show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
15604 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
15605 possible to dump only selected items :
15606 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
15607 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
15608 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
15609 for example:
15610 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
15611 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
15612 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
15613
15614 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015615 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
15616 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015617 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
15618 Release_date: 2009/09/23
15619 Nbproc: 1
15620 Process_num: 1
15621 (...)
15622
15623 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
15624 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
15625 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
15626 (...)
15627 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
15628
15629 $
15630
15631 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
15632 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
15633 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
15634 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015635 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015636
Baptiste Assmann3863f972015-05-17 00:33:24 +020015637show stat resolvers <resolvers section id>
15638 Dump statistics for the given resolvers section.
15639 For each name server, the following counters are reported:
15640 sent: number of DNS requests sent to this server
15641 valid: number of DNS valid responses received from this server
15642 update: number of DNS responses used to update the server's IP address
15643 cname: number of CNAME responses
15644 cname_error: CNAME errors encountered with this server
15645 any_err: number of empty response (IE: server does not support ANY type)
15646 nx: non existent domain response received from this server
15647 timeout: how many time this server did not answer in time
15648 refused: number of requests refused by this server
15649 other: any other DNS errors
15650 invalid: invalid DNS response (from a protocol point of view)
15651 too_big: too big response
15652 outdated: number of response arrived too late (after an other name server)
15653
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015654show table
15655 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
15656 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
15657 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
15658 entries currently in use.
15659
15660 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015661 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015662 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
15663 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015664
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015665show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015666 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
15667 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
15668 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015669 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
15670
15671 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
15672 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
15673 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
15674 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
15675 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
15676
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015677 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15678 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15679 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15680 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15681 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15682 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15683
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015684
15685 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015686 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
15687 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015688
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015689 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015690 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015691 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015692 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15693 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15694 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15695 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015696
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015697 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015698 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015699 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15700 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015701
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015702 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
15703 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015704 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015705 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15706 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015707
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015708 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
15709 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015710 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015711 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15712 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
15713
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015714 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
15715 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
15716 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
15717 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
15718 time goes, the average event rate drops.
15719
15720 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
15721 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
15722 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015723 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
15724 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015725 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
15726 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020015727
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015728show tls-keys
15729 Dump all loaded TLS ticket keys. The TLS ticket key reference ID and the
15730 file from which the keys have been loaded is shown. Both of those can be
15731 used to update the TLS keys using "set ssl tls-key".
15732
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015733shutdown frontend <frontend>
15734 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
15735 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
15736 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
15737 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
15738 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
15739 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
15740 once it is terminated.
15741
15742 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15743 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15744
15745 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15746 level "admin".
15747
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020015748shutdown session <id>
15749 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
15750 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15751 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
15752 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
15753 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
15754 flag in the logs.
15755
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020015756shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015757 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
15758 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
15759 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
15760 'K' flag in the logs.
15761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015762/*
15763 * Local variables:
15764 * fill-column: 79
15765 * End:
15766 */